blob: 832373785d0fde09ab800128f41e844528dd3431 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6e893b92019-03-26 05:40:51 +01007 2019/03/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200583 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100584 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200585 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200588 - ssl-default-bind-options
589 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - ssl-default-server-options
592 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100593 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100594 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100595 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100596 - 51degrees-data-file
597 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200598 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200599 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200600 - wurfl-data-file
601 - wurfl-information-list
602 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200603 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200606 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200608 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100609 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100610 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100611 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200612 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200613 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200614 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200615 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 - noepoll
617 - nokqueue
618 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100619 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300620 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000621 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100622 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200623 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200624 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200625 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000626 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000627 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200628 - tune.buffers.limit
629 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200630 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200631 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100632 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200633 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200634 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200635 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100636 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200637 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200638 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100639 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100640 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100641 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100642 - tune.lua.session-timeout
643 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200644 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100645 - tune.maxaccept
646 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200647 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200648 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200649 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100650 - tune.rcvbuf.client
651 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100652 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200653 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100654 - tune.sndbuf.client
655 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100656 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100657 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200658 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100659 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200660 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200661 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100662 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200663 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100664 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200665 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
666 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
667 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100668 - tune.zlib.memlevel
669 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100670
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200671 * Debugging
672 - debug
673 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674
675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006763.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200677------------------------------------
678
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200679ca-base <dir>
680 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200681 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
682 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200683
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200684chroot <jail dir>
685 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
686 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
687 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
688 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
689 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100690 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100691
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100692cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
693 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
694 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
695 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
696 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
697 set. These sets have the format
698
699 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
700
701 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100702 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100703 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
704 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100705 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
706 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100707 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100708 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100709 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100710 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100711 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
712 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
713 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
714 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100715
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100716 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
717 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
718 on the machine's word size.
719
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100720 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100721 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
722 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
723 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
724 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
725 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
726 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100727
728 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100729 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
730
731 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
732 # first 4 CPUs
733
734 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
735 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
736 # word size.
737
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100738 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100739 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100740 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
743
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100744 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
745 # and so on.
746 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
749
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100750 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100751 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
752 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
753 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
754
755 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
756 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
757 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
758
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
760 # and a thread range.
761 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
762 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
764
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200765crt-base <dir>
766 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
767 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
768 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200770daemon
771 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
772 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100773 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
774 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200775
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200776deviceatlas-json-file <path>
777 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100778 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200779
780deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100781 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200782 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
783
784deviceatlas-separator <char>
785 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
786 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
787
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100788deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200789 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
790 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
791 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100792
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900793external-check
794 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
795 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
796 See "option external-check".
797
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200798gid <number>
799 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
800 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
801 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100802 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
803 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100805
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100806hard-stop-after <time>
807 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
808
809 Arguments :
810 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
811 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
812 SIGUSR1 signal.
813
814 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
815 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
816 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
817
818 Example:
819 global
820 hard-stop-after 30s
821
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822group <group name>
823 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
824 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100825
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200826log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100827 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100828 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100829 configured with "log global".
830
831 <address> can be one of:
832
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100833 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100834 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
835 port).
836
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100837 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
838 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
839 port).
840
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100841 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100842 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
843 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100844 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100845
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100846 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
847 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
848 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
849 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
850 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
851 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
852 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
853 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
854 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
855 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
856 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
857 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
858 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
859 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100860 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
861 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100862
863 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
864 "fd@2", see above.
865
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200866 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
867 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100868
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200869 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
870 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
871 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
872 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
873 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
874 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
875 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
876 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
877 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
878 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100879 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
880 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200881
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200882 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
883 one of the following :
884
885 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
886 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
887
888 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
889 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
890
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100891 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
892 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
893 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
894 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
895 logger consumes.
896
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100897 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
898 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
899 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
900 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
901
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100902 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200903
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100904 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
905 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
906 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
907
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100908 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
909 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
910 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
911 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200912
913 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200914 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
915 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
916 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
917 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
918 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
919 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200920
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200921 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200922
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100923log-send-hostname [<string>]
924 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
925 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
926 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
927 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
928 the logs.
929
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000930log-tag <string>
931 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
932 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
933 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100934 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000935
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100936lua-load <file>
937 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
938 used multiple times.
939
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100940master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200941 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
942 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
943 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100944 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200945 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
946 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100947 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
948 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
949 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
950 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
951 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200952
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100953 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200954
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200955nbproc <number>
956 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
957 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
958 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100959 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
960 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100961 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
962 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200963
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200964nbthread <number>
965 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +0100966 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
967 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
968 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
969 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
970 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100971 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
972 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
973 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
974 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
975 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
976 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
977 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200978
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200979pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100980 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200981 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
982 starting the process. See also "daemon".
983
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100984presetenv <name> <value>
985 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
986 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
987 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
988 and "unsetenv".
989
990resetenv [<name> ...]
991 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
992 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
993 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
994 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
995 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
996 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
997 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
998 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
999
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001000stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001001 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1002 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1003 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1004 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1005 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1006 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001007 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001008 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1009 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1010 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1011 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001012
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001013server-state-base <directory>
1014 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001015 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1016 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001017
1018server-state-file <file>
1019 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1020 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1021 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1022 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1023 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1024 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1025 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1026 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001027 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1028 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001029
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001030setenv <name> <value>
1031 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1032 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1033 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1034 and "unsetenv".
1035
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001036set-dumpable
1037 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1038 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1039 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1040 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1041 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1042 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1043 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1044 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1045 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1046 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1047 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1048 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1049 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1050 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1051 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1052 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1053 expected when dying.
1054
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001055ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1056 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1057 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001058 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001059 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001060 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1061 information and recommendations see e.g.
1062 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1063 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1064 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1065 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001066
1067ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1068 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1069 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1070 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1071 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1072 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001073 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1074 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1075 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001076 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001077
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001078ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1079 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1080 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1081 keyword to see available options.
1082
1083 Example:
1084 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001085 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001086
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001087ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1088 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1089 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001090 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001091 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001092 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1093 information and recommendations see e.g.
1094 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1095 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1096 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1097 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1098 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001099
1100ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1101 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1102 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1103 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1104 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1105 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001106 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1107 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1108 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1109 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001110
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001111ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1112 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1113 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1114 keyword to see available options.
1115
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001116ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1117 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1118 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1119 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001120 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001121 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001122 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1123 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1124 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1125 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001126 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1127 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1128 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1129
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001130ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1131 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1132 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1133 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1134
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001135stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1136 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1137 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1138 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001139 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001140 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001141
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001142 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1143 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1144 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001145
1146stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1147 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1148 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001149 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001150
1151stats maxconn <connections>
1152 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1153 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1154
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001155uid <number>
1156 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1157 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1158 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1159 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1160
1161ulimit-n <number>
1162 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1163 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1164 option.
1165
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001166unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1167 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1168
1169 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1170 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1171 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1172 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1173 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1174 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1175 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1176 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1177 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1178 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1179
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001180unsetenv [<name> ...]
1181 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1182 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1183 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1184 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1185 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1186 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1187 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1188
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001189user <user name>
1190 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1191 See also "uid" and "group".
1192
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001193node <name>
1194 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1195
1196 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1197 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1198 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1199 traffic.
1200
1201description <text>
1202 Add a text that describes the instance.
1203
1204 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1205 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1206 "<" and ">" characters.
1207
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100120851degrees-data-file <file path>
1209 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001210 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001211
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001212 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001213 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1214
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000121551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001216 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1217 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1218 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1219
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001220 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001221 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1222
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200122351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001224 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1225 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1226
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001227 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1228 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1229
123051degrees-cache-size <number>
1231 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1232 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1233 By default, this cache is disabled.
1234
1235 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001236 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1237
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001238wurfl-data-file <file path>
1239 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1240 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1241
1242 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1243 with USE_WURFL=1.
1244
1245wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1246 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1247 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1248 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1249
1250 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1251
1252 Valid WURFL properties are:
1253 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1254
1255 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1256 device.
1257
1258 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1259 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1260
1261 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1262 particular web request.
1263
1264 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1265 used Libwurfl API version.
1266
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001267 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1268 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1269
1270 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1271 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1272
1273 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1274
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001275 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1276 with USE_WURFL=1.
1277
1278wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1279 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1280 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1281
1282 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1283 with USE_WURFL=1.
1284
1285wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1286 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1287 thus before the chroot.
1288
1289 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1290 with USE_WURFL=1.
1291
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001292wurfl-cache-size <size>
1293 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1294 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001295 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001296 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001297
1298 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1299 with USE_WURFL=1.
1300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013013.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001302-----------------------
1303
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001304busy-polling
1305 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1306 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1307 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1308 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1309 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1310 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1311 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1312 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1313 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1314 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1315 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1316 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1317 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1318 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1319 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1320 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1321 "poll" pollers.
1322
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001323max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1324 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1325 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1326 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1327 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1328 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1329 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1330 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1331 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1332
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001333maxconn <number>
1334 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1335 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1336 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001337 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1338 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1339 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1340 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001341 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1342 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1343 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1344 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1345 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1346 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001347
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001348maxconnrate <number>
1349 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1350 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1351 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1352 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1353 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1354 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1355 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1356 fairness.
1357
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001358maxcomprate <number>
1359 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001360 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001361 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1362 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1363 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001364 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001365 default value.
1366
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001367maxcompcpuusage <number>
1368 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1369 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1370 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1371 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1372 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1373 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1374 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1375 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1376
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001377maxpipes <number>
1378 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1379 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1380 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1381 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1382 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1383 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1384
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001385maxsessrate <number>
1386 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1387 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1388 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1389 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1390 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1391 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1392 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1393 fairness.
1394
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001395maxsslconn <number>
1396 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1397 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1398 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1399 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1400 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1401 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1402 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001403 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1404 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1405 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1406 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1407 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1408 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1409 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001410
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001411maxsslrate <number>
1412 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1413 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1414 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1415 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1416 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1417 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1418 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1419 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1420 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1421 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1422
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001423maxzlibmem <number>
1424 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1425 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1426 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001427 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1428 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1429 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1430
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001431noepoll
1432 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1433 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001434 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001435
1436nokqueue
1437 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1438 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1439 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1440
1441nopoll
1442 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1443 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001444 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001445 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001446
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001447nosplice
1448 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001449 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001450 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001451 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001452 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1453 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1454 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1455 "option splice-response".
1456
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001457nogetaddrinfo
1458 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1459 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1460
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001461noreuseport
1462 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1463 command line argument "-dR".
1464
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001465profiling.tasks { on | off }
1466 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. CPU profiling per
1467 task can be very convenient to report where the time is spent and which
1468 requests have what effect on which other request. It is not enabled by
1469 default as it may consume a little bit extra CPU. This requires a system
1470 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1471 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1472 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1473 CLI.
1474
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001475spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001476 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1477 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1478 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1479 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1480 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1481 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001482
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001483ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001484 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001485 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001486 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1487 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1488 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1489 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1490 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001491 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1492 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001493 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1494 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1495 openssl configuration file uses:
1496 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1497
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001498ssl-mode-async
1499 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001500 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001501 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1502 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1503 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1504 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1505 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001506
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001507tune.buffers.limit <number>
1508 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1509 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1510 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1511 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1512 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001513 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001514 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1515 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1516 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1517 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1518 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1519 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1520 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1521 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1522 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1523
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001524tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1525 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1526 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1527 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1528 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1529
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001530tune.bufsize <number>
1531 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1532 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1533 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1534 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1535 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1536 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1537 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001538 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1539 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1540 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001541 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001542 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1543 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1544 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001545
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001546tune.chksize <number>
1547 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1548 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1549 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1550 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1551 checks whenever possible.
1552
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001553tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1554 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1555 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1556 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1557 this value. The default value is 1.
1558
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001559tune.fail-alloc
1560 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1561 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1562 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1563 gracefully.
1564
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001565tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1566 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1567 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1568 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1569 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1570 change it.
1571
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001572tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1573 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001574 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1575 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001576 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1577 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1578 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1579 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1580 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1581
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001582tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1583 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1584 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1585 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1586 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1587 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1588 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1589 recommended not to change this value.
1590
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001591tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1592 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1593 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1594 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1595 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1596 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1597 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1598 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1599
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001600tune.http.cookielen <number>
1601 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1602 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1603 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1604 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1605 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1606 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1607 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1608 to change this value.
1609
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001610tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001611 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1612 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001613 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001614 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001615 configuration directives too.
1616 The default value is 1024.
1617
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001618tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1619 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1620 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1621 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1622 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1623 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1624 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001625 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1626 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1627 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001628
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001629tune.idletimer <timeout>
1630 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1631 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1632 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1633 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1634 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1635 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001636 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001637 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1638 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1639
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001640tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1641 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1642 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1643 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1644 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1645 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1646 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1647 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1648 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1649 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1650
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001651tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1652 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001653 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001654 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1655 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001656 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001657 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1658 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1659
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001660tune.lua.maxmem
1661 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1662 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1663 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1664 memory.
1665
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001666tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1667 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001668 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1669 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001670 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001671
1672tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1673 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1674 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1675 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1676 check servers.
1677
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001678tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1679 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1680 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1681 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001682 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001683
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001684tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001685 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1686 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1687 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1688 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1689 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1690 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1691 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1692 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1693 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1694 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001695
1696tune.maxpollevents <number>
1697 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1698 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1699 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1700 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1701 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1702
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001703tune.maxrewrite <number>
1704 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1705 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1706 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1707 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1708 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1709 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1710 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1711 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1712 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1713 bufsize.
1714
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001715tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1716 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1717 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1718 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1719 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1720 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1721 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1722 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1723 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1724 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1725 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1726 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1727 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1728 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1729 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1730 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1731 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1732 setting this parameter to 0.
1733
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001734tune.pipesize <number>
1735 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1736 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1737 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1738 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1739 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1740 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1741
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001742tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1743 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1744 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1745 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1746 default is 20.
1747
1748tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1749 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1750 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1751 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1752 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1753 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1754 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
1755 much sense in the general case when targetting connection reuse).
1756
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001757tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1758tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1759 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1760 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1761 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1762 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001763 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001764 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1765 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1766
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001767tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001768 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001769 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1770 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1771 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1772 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1773
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001774tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1775 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1776 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1777 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1778
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001779tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1780tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1781 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1782 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1783 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1784 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001785 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001786 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1787 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1788 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1789 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1790 notifying haproxy again.
1791
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001792tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001793 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1794 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1795 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001796 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001797 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001798 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001799 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1800 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1801 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001802 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1803 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001804
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001805tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001806 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001807 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1808 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1809 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1810 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1811 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1812
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001813tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1814 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001815 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001816 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1817 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1818 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1819 being used for too long.
1820
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001821tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1822 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1823 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1824 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1825 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1826 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1827 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1828 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1829 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1830 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1831 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001832 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001833 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001834
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001835tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1836 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1837 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1838 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1839 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1840 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1841 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1842 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001843 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1844 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001845
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001846tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1847 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1848 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1849 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1850 1000 entries.
1851
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001852tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1853 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1854 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1855 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1856
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001857tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001858tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001859tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1860tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1861tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001862 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1863 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1864 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1865 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1866 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1867 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1868 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1869 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001870
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001871 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1872 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1873 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1874 all available space is consumed.
1875 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1876 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1877 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001878
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001879tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1880 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001881 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001882 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001883 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001884 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1885
1886tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1887 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1888 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001889 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1890 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001891
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018923.3. Debugging
1893--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001894
1895debug
1896 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1897 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1898 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1899 system startup.
1900
1901quiet
1902 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1903 line argument "-q".
1904
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001905
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019063.4. Userlists
1907--------------
1908It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1909http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1910it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1911
1912userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001913 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001914 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1915
1916group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001917 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001918 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1919 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1920
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001921user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1922 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001923 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1924 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001925 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1926 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1927 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1928 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001929
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001930 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1931 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1932 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1933 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1934 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1935 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1936 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1937 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1938 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001939
1940 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001941 userlist L1
1942 group G1 users tiger,scott
1943 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001944
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001945 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1946 user scott insecure-password elgato
1947 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001948
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001949 userlist L2
1950 group G1
1951 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001952
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001953 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1954 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1955 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001956
1957 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001958
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001959
19603.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001961----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001962It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1963several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1964instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1965values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1966automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1967In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1968using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1969tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1970reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1971Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1972that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1973each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001974
1975peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001976 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001977 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1978
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001979bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1980 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
1981 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
1982
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001983disabled
1984 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1985 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1986 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1987
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001988default-bind [param*]
1989 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
1990
1991default-server [param*]
1992 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
1993
1994 Arguments:
1995 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1996 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1997 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1998 details.
1999
2000
2001 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2002
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002003enable
2004 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2005
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002006peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002007 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2008 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2009 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2010 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2011 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2012 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2013
2014 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2015 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2016
2017 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2018 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2019 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2020 across all peers.
2021
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002022 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2023 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002024
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002025 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2026 "server" keyword explanation below).
2027
2028server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
2029 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
2030 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2031 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2032 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2033 of this "peers" section).
2034 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2035
2036
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002037 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002038 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002039 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002040 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2041 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2042 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002043
2044 backend mybackend
2045 mode tcp
2046 balance roundrobin
2047 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2048 stick on src
2049
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002050 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2051 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002052
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002053 Example:
2054 peers mypeers
2055 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2056 default-server ssl verify none
2057 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2058 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002059
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090020603.6. Mailers
2061------------
2062It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2063If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2064in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2065
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002066mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002067 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2068 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2069
2070mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2071 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2072
2073 Example:
2074 mailers mymailers
2075 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2076 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2077
2078 backend mybackend
2079 mode tcp
2080 balance roundrobin
2081
2082 email-alert mailers mymailers
2083 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2084 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2085
2086 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2087 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2088
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002089timeout mail <time>
2090 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2091 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2092 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2093 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2094
2095 Example:
2096 mailers mymailers
2097 timeout mail 20s
2098 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021004. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002101----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002102
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002103Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002104 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002105 - frontend <name>
2106 - backend <name>
2107 - listen <name>
2108
2109A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2110its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2111section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002112section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002113
2114A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2115connections.
2116
2117A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2118to forward incoming connections.
2119
2120A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2121parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2122
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002123All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2124'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2125case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2126
2127Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2128logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2129proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2130However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2131name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2132
2133Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2134and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002135bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002136protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2137modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2138arbitrary criteria.
2139
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002140In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2141a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002142the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002143
2144 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2145 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2146 between responses and new requests.
2147
2148 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2149 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2150 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002151 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2152 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2153 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2154 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002155
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002156 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2157 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2158 client-facing connection remains open.
2159
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002160 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2161 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002162
2163The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2164frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2165following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002166weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002167
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002168 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002169
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002170 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2171 ----+-----+-----+----
2172 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2173 ----+-----+-----+----
2174 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2175 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2176 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2177 ----+-----+-----+----
2178 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002179
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002180
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021824.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2183--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002184
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002185The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2186limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2187they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2188limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002189marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002190option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002191and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2192with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2193specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002194
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002195
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002196 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2197------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2198acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002199appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002200backlog X X X -
2201balance X - X X
2202bind - X X -
2203bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002204block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002205capture cookie - X X -
2206capture request header - X X -
2207capture response header - X X -
2208clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002209compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002210contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2211cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002212declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002213default-server X - X X
2214default_backend X X X -
2215description - X X X
2216disabled X X X X
2217dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002218email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002219email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002220email-alert mailers X X X X
2221email-alert myhostname X X X X
2222email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002223enabled X X X X
2224errorfile X X X X
2225errorloc X X X X
2226errorloc302 X X X X
2227-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2228errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002229force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002230filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002231fullconn X - X X
2232grace X X X X
2233hash-type X - X X
2234http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002235http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002236http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002237http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002238http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002239http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002240http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002241id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002242ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002243load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002244log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002245log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002246log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002247log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002248max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002249maxconn X X X -
2250mode X X X X
2251monitor fail - X X -
2252monitor-net X X X -
2253monitor-uri X X X -
2254option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2255option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2256option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2257option allbackups (*) X - X X
2258option checkcache (*) X - X X
2259option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2260option contstats (*) X X X -
2261option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2262option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002263option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002264-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2265option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002266option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002267option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002268option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002269option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002270option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002271option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002272option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002273option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002274option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002275option httpchk X - X X
2276option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002277option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002278option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002279option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002280option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002281option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002282option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2283option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2284option logasap (*) X X X -
2285option mysql-check X - X X
2286option nolinger (*) X X X X
2287option originalto X X X X
2288option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002289option pgsql-check X - X X
2290option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002291option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002292option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002293option smtpchk X - X X
2294option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2295option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2296option splice-request (*) X X X X
2297option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002298option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002299option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2300option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2301-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002302option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002303option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2304option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2305option tcpka X X X X
2306option tcplog X X X X
2307option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002308external-check command X - X X
2309external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002310persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2311rate-limit sessions X X X -
2312redirect - X X X
2313redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2314redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2315reqadd - X X X
2316reqallow - X X X
2317reqdel - X X X
2318reqdeny - X X X
2319reqiallow - X X X
2320reqidel - X X X
2321reqideny - X X X
2322reqipass - X X X
2323reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002324reqitarpit - X X X
2325reqpass - X X X
2326reqrep - X X X
2327-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002328reqtarpit - X X X
2329retries X - X X
2330rspadd - X X X
2331rspdel - X X X
2332rspdeny - X X X
2333rspidel - X X X
2334rspideny - X X X
2335rspirep - X X X
2336rsprep - X X X
2337server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002338server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002339server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002340source X - X X
2341srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002342stats admin - X X X
2343stats auth X X X X
2344stats enable X X X X
2345stats hide-version X X X X
2346stats http-request - X X X
2347stats realm X X X X
2348stats refresh X X X X
2349stats scope X X X X
2350stats show-desc X X X X
2351stats show-legends X X X X
2352stats show-node X X X X
2353stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002354-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2355stick match - - X X
2356stick on - - X X
2357stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002358stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002359stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002360tcp-check connect - - X X
2361tcp-check expect - - X X
2362tcp-check send - - X X
2363tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002364tcp-request connection - X X -
2365tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002366tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002367tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002368tcp-response content - - X X
2369tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002370timeout check X - X X
2371timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002372timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002373timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2374timeout connect X - X X
2375timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2376timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2377timeout http-request X X X X
2378timeout queue X - X X
2379timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002380timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002381timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2382timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002383timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002384transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002385unique-id-format X X X -
2386unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002387use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002388use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002389------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2390 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002391
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002392
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023934.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2394---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002395
2396This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2397
2398
2399acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2400 Declare or complete an access list.
2401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2402 no | yes | yes | yes
2403 Example:
2404 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2405 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2406 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2407
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002408 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002409
2410
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002411appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2412 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002413 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2415 no | no | yes | yes
2416 Arguments :
2417 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2418 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2419
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002420 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002421 checked in each cookie value.
2422
2423 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2424 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2425 milliseconds.
2426
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002427 request-learn
2428 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2429 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2430 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2431 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2432 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2433 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2434
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002435 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2436 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2437 data following this prefix.
2438
2439 Example :
2440 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2441
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002442 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2443 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002444
2445 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2446 2 modes are currently supported :
2447 - path-parameters :
2448 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2449 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2450 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2451 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2452 - query-string :
2453 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2454 query string.
2455
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002456 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2457 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2458 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002459
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002460 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2461 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002462
2463
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002464backlog <conns>
2465 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2467 yes | yes | yes | no
2468 Arguments :
2469 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2470 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002471 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002472
2473 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2474 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2475 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2476 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2477 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2478 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2479 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2480 backlog parameter.
2481
2482 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2483 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2484 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2485
2486 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2487
2488
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002489balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002490balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002491 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2493 yes | no | yes | yes
2494 Arguments :
2495 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2496 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2497 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2498 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2499
2500 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2501 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2502 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2503 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002504 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002505 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002506 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2507 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2508 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2509 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2510 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2511 it, so that you don't worry.
2512
2513 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2514 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2515 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2516 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2517 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2518 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2519 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2520 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002521
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002522 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2523 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2524 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2525 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2526 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2527 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2528 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2529 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2530
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002531 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002532 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002533 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2534 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002535 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002536 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2537 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2538 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2539 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2540 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002541 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2542 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2543 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2544 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2545 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2546 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002547
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002548 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2549 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2550 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2551 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2552 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2553 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2554 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2555 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002556 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002557 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002558 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2559 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2560 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002561
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002562 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2563 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2564 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2565 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2566 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2567 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2568 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2569 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2570 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2571 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2572 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2573 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002574
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002575 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002576 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2577 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2578 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2579 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2580 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2581 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2582 URIs start with a leading "/".
2583
2584 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2585 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2586 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2587 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2588
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002589 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002590 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2591
2592 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002593 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2594 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002595 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2596 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2597 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2598 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002599 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002600 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2601 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002602
2603 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2604 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2605 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2606 server will receive the request.
2607
2608 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2609 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2610 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2611 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2612 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002613 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2614 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2615 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002616
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002617 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2618 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2619 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2620 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2621 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002622
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002623 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002624 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2625 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2626 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2627
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002628 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2629 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2630 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2631
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002632 random
2633 random(<draws>)
2634 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002635 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2636 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2637 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2638 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002639 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2640 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2641 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2642 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2643 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2644 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2645 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2646 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2647 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2648 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2649 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2650 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2651 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2652 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2653 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2654 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2655 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2656 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2657 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2658 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002659
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002660 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002661 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002662 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2663 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2664 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2665 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2666 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2667 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002668 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002669 used instead.
2670
2671 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2672 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2673 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2674 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2675
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002676 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2677 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2678 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2679
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002680 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002681
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002682 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002683 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2684 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002685
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002686 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2687 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2688 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002689
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002690 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2691 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2692 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2693 NTLM relies on.
2694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002695 Examples :
2696 balance roundrobin
2697 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002698 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002699 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2700 balance hdr(host)
2701 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002702
2703 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2704 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2705
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002706 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002707 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2708 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2709 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2710 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2711
2712 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2713 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2714 defaults to 16 kB.
2715
2716 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2717 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2718
2719 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2720 Round Robin.
2721
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002722 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002723 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2724 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2725 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2726
2727 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2728
2729 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002730 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002731 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2732 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2733 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002734
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002735 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002736
2737
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002738bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2739bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002740 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2742 no | yes | yes | no
2743 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002744 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2745 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2746 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2747 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002748 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002749 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2750 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2751 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2752 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2753 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2754 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2755 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002756 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2757 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2758 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2759 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2760 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2761 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2762 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002763 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2764 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2765 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002766 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2767 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2768 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2769 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002770 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2771 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2772 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002773
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002774 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2775 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002776 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2777 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2778 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002779 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2780 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2781 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2782 the range.
2783
2784 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2785 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2786 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2787 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2788 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2789 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2790 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002791 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002792 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002793
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002794 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002795 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002796 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2797 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2798 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2799 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2800 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2801 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2802
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002803 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2804 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2805 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2806 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002807
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002808 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2809 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2810 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2811 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2812 in a frontend.
2813
2814 Example :
2815 listen http_proxy
2816 bind :80,:443
2817 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002818 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002819
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002820 listen http_https_proxy
2821 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002822 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002823
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002824 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2825 bind ipv6@:80
2826 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2827 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2828
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002829 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002830 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002831
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002832 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2833 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2834 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2835 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2836 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2837
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002838 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002839 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002840
2841
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002842bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002843 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2845 yes | yes | yes | yes
2846 Arguments :
2847 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2848 may be used to override a default value.
2849
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002850 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002851 option may be combined with other numbers.
2852
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002853 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002854 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2855 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2856 missing from all processes.
2857
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002858 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002859 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002860 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2861 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2862 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2863 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2864 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002865 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002866
2867 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2868 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2869 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2870 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2871 and 'even' instances.
2872
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002873 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2874 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2875 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2876 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002877
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002878 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2879 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2880
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002881 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2882 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2883 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2884
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002885 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2886 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2887
2888 Example :
2889 listen app_ip1
2890 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002891 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002892
2893 listen app_ip2
2894 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002895 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002896
2897 listen management
2898 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002899 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002900
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002901 listen management
2902 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2903 bind-process 1-4
2904
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002905 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002906
2907
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002908block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002909 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2911 no | yes | yes | yes
2912
2913 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2914 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002915 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002916 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002918 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2919 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2920 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002921
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002922 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2923 "http-request deny" instead.
2924
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925 Example:
2926 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2927 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2928 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002929 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2930 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2931 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002932
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002933 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2934 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2935 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002936
2937capture cookie <name> len <length>
2938 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2940 no | yes | yes | no
2941 Arguments :
2942 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2943 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2944 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2945 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002946 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002947
2948 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2949 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2950 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2951 right if it exceeds <length>.
2952
2953 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2954 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2955 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2956 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2957
2958 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2959 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2960 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2961
2962 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2963 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2964 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002965 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2966 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2967 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002968
2969 Example:
2970 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2971
2972 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002973 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002974
2975
2976capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002977 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2979 no | yes | yes | no
2980 Arguments :
2981 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002982 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002983 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2984 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2985 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2986
2987 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2988 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2989 it exceeds <length>.
2990
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002991 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002992 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2993 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002994 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2995 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2996 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2997 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002998 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002999 environments to find where the request came from.
3000
3001 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3002 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3003 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3004 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003005
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003006 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3007 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3008 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3009 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3010 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003011
3012 Example:
3013 capture request header Host len 15
3014 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003015 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003016
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003017 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003018 about logging.
3019
3020
3021capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003022 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3024 no | yes | yes | no
3025 Arguments :
3026 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003027 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003028 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3029 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3030 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3031
3032 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3033 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3034 it exceeds <length>.
3035
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003036 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003037 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3038 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3039 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003040 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3041 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3042 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3043 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003044
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003045 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3046 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3047 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3048 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3049 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003050
3051 Example:
3052 capture response header Content-length len 9
3053 capture response header Location len 15
3054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003055 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003056 about logging.
3057
3058
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003059clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003060 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3062 yes | yes | yes | no
3063 Arguments :
3064 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3065 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3066 as explained at the top of this document.
3067
3068 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3069 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3070 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3071 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3072 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3073 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3074 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3075 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003076 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003078 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003079
3080 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3081 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3082 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3083 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3084 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3085 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3086
3087 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3088 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3089
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003090 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3091 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003092
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003093compression algo <algorithm> ...
3094compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003095compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003096 Enable HTTP compression.
3097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3098 yes | yes | yes | yes
3099 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003100 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3101 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3102 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3103
3104 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003105 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3106 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3107 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003108
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003109 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003110 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003111
3112 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3113 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3114 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3115 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3116 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003117 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003118
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003119 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3120 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3121 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3122 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3123 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3124 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3125 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003126 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003127
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003128 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003129 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003130 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3131 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3132 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3133 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3134 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003135
3136 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3137 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3138 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3139 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3140 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003141 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3142 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3143 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3144 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3145 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003146 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3147 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003148
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003149 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003150 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3151 "Accept-Encoding" header
3152 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003153 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003154 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3155 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3156 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3157 "multipart"
3158 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3159 header
3160 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3161 and later
3162 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3163 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003164 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003165
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003166 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003167
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003168 Examples :
3169 compression algo gzip
3170 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003171
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003172
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003173contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003174 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3176 yes | no | yes | yes
3177 Arguments :
3178 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3179 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3180 as explained at the top of this document.
3181
3182 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003183 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003184 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003185 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003186 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3187 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3188 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3189
3190 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3191 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3192 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3193 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3194 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3195 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3196
3197 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3198 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3199 instead.
3200
3201 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3202 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3203
3204
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003205cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003206 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3207 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003208 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003209 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3211 yes | no | yes | yes
3212 Arguments :
3213 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3214 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3215 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3216 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3217 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3218 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003219 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003220 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3221 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3222
3223 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3224 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3225 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3226 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3227 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3228 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003229 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3230 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003231 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003232 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3233 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003234
3235 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003236 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003237
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003238 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003239 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3240 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003241 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003242 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3243 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3244 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3245 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3246 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3247 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3248 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003249
3250 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3251 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3252 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3253 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3254 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3255 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3256 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3257 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3258 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003259 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003260 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3261 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3262 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003263
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003264 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3265 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3266 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003267 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3268 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3269 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3270 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003271 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3272 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3273 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003274
3275 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3276 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3277 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3278 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3279 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3280 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3281 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3282 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3283 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3284
3285 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3286 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3287 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3288 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3289 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3290 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3291 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3292 persistence cookie in the cache.
3293 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3294
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003295 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3296 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3297 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3298 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3299 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003300 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003301 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3302 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3303 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3304 they logout.
3305
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003306 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3307 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3308 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3309 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3310
3311 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3312 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3313 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3314 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3315 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3316 this attribute.
3317
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003318 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003319 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003320 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3321 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3322 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3323 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3324 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3325 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003326
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003327 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3328 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3329 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3330 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3331 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3332 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3333 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3334 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003335 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003336 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3337 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3338 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3339 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3340 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3341 the site.
3342
3343 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3344 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3345 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3346 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3347 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3348 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3349 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3350 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3351 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3352 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3353 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3354 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3355 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003356 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003357 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3358 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3359
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003360 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3361 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3362 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3363 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3364 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3365 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003367 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3368 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3369 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3370 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003372 Examples :
3373 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3374 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3375 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003376 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003377
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003378 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003379
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003380
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003381declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3382 Declares a capture slot.
3383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3384 no | yes | yes | no
3385 Arguments:
3386 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3387
3388 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3389 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3390 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3391 for use in the response.
3392
3393 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003394 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003395 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3396
3397
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003398default-server [param*]
3399 Change default options for a server in a backend
3400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3401 yes | no | yes | yes
3402 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003403 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3404 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3405 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3406 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003407
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003408 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003409 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3410
3411 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003412
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003413
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003414default_backend <backend>
3415 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3417 yes | yes | yes | no
3418 Arguments :
3419 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3420
3421 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3422 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3423 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3424 will catch all undetermined requests.
3425
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003426 Example :
3427
3428 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3429 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3430 default_backend dynamic
3431
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003432 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003433
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003434
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003435description <string>
3436 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3438 no | yes | yes | yes
3439 Arguments : string
3440
3441 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3442 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3443 it describes.
3444 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3445
3446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003447disabled
3448 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3450 yes | yes | yes | yes
3451 Arguments : none
3452
3453 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3454 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3455 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3456 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3457 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3458 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3459 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3460
3461 See also : "enabled"
3462
3463
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003464dispatch <address>:<port>
3465 Set a default server address
3466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3467 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003468 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003469
3470 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3471 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3472 during start-up.
3473
3474 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3475 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3476 possible with normal servers.
3477
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003478 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003479 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3480 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3481 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3482 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3483
3484 See also : "server"
3485
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003486
3487dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3488 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3490 yes | no | yes | yes
3491 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3492
3493 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003494 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003495 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3496 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003497 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003498 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003499
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003500enabled
3501 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3503 yes | yes | yes | yes
3504 Arguments : none
3505
3506 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3507 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3508
3509 See also : "disabled"
3510
3511
3512errorfile <code> <file>
3513 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3515 yes | yes | yes | yes
3516 Arguments :
3517 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003518 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3519 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003520
3521 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003522 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003523 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003524 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3525 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003526
3527 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3528 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3529 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3530
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003531 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3532
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003533 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3534 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3535 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3536 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3537
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003538 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3539 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003540 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003541 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3542 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3543 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3544
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003545 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3546 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3547 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003548 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003549 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3550
3551 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3552
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003553 Example :
3554 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003555 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003556 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3557 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3558
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003559
3560errorloc <code> <url>
3561errorloc302 <code> <url>
3562 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3564 yes | yes | yes | yes
3565 Arguments :
3566 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003567 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3568 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003569
3570 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3571 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3572 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3573 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003574 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003575
3576 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3577 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3578 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3579
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003580 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3581
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003582 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3583 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3584 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3585 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003586 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003587 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3588 request.
3589
3590 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3591
3592
3593errorloc303 <code> <url>
3594 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3596 yes | yes | yes | yes
3597 Arguments :
3598 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003599 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3600 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003601
3602 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3603 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3604 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3605 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003606 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003607
3608 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3609 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3610 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3611
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003612 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3613
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003614 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3615 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3616 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3617 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003618 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003619
3620 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3621
3622
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003623email-alert from <emailaddr>
3624 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003625 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003626 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3627 yes | yes | yes | yes
3628
3629 Arguments :
3630
3631 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3632
3633 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3634 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3635
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003636 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003637 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3638 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003639
3640
3641email-alert level <level>
3642 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3643 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3644 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3645 yes | yes | yes | yes
3646
3647 Arguments :
3648
3649 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3650 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3651 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3652
3653 By default level is alert
3654
3655 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3656 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3657 for the proxy.
3658
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003659 Alerts are sent when :
3660
3661 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3662 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3663 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3664 is notice or lower
3665 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3666 and a health check status update occurs
3667
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003668 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3669 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003670 section 3.6 about mailers.
3671
3672
3673email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3674 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3675 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3676 yes | yes | yes | yes
3677
3678 Arguments :
3679
3680 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3681
3682 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3683 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3684
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003685 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3686 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003687
3688
3689email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3690 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3691 mailers.
3692 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3693 yes | yes | yes | yes
3694
3695 Arguments :
3696
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003697 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003698
3699 By default the systems hostname is used.
3700
3701 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3702 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3703 for the proxy.
3704
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003705 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3706 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003707
3708
3709email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003710 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003711 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3712 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3713 yes | yes | yes | yes
3714
3715 Arguments :
3716
3717 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3718
3719 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3720 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3721
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003722 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003723 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3724
3725
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003726force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3727 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3728 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003729 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003730
3731 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3732 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3733 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3734 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3735 marked down for maintenance operations.
3736
3737 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3738 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3739 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3740 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3741 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3742 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3743 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3744 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3745 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3746
3747 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3748 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3749 is used.
3750
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003751 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003752 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003753
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003754
3755filter <name> [param*]
3756 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3758 no | yes | yes | yes
3759 Arguments :
3760 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3761 referenced in section 9.
3762
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003763 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003764 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003765 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3766 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003767
3768 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3769 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3770
3771 Example:
3772 listen
3773 bind *:80
3774
3775 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3776 filter compression
3777 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3778
3779 compression algo gzip
3780 compression offload
3781
3782 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3783
3784 See also : section 9.
3785
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003786
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003787fullconn <conns>
3788 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3790 yes | no | yes | yes
3791 Arguments :
3792 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3793 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3794
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003795 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003796 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003797 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003798 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3799 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3800 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3801 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3802 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003803 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003804
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003805 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3806 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003807 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3808 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3809 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003810
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003811 Example :
3812 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3813 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3814 # connections.
3815 backend dynamic
3816 fullconn 10000
3817 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3818 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3819
3820 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3821
3822
3823grace <time>
3824 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003826 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003827 Arguments :
3828 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3829 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3830 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3831
3832 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3833 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003834 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003835 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3836
3837 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3838 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3839 simplify it.
3840
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003841
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003842hash-balance-factor <factor>
3843 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3845 yes | no | no | yes
3846 Arguments :
3847 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3848 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003849 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003850
3851 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3852 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3853 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3854 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3855 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3856 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3857 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3858
3859 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3860 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3861 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3862 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3863 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3864
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003865 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3866 consistent hashing mechanism.
3867
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003868 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3869
3870
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003871hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003872 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3874 yes | no | yes | yes
3875 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003876 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3877 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003878
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003879 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3880 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3881 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3882 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3883 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3884 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3885 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3886 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3887 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3888 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003889
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003890 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3891 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3892 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3893 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3894 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3895 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3896 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3897 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3898 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3899 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3900 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3901 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3902 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003903 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3904 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003905
3906 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3907
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003908 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003909 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3910 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3911 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003912 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3913 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3914 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003915
3916 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3917 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003918 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3919 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3920 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3921 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3922
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003923 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3924 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3925 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3926 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3927 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3928 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3929 parameter.
3930
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003931 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3932 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3933 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3934 used on strings.
3935
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003936 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3937
3938 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3939 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3940 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3941 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3942 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3943 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3944 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3945 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3946 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3947 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3948 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3949 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003950
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003951 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3952 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3953 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003954
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003955 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003956
3957
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003958http-check disable-on-404
3959 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003961 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003962 Arguments : none
3963
3964 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3965 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3966 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3967 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3968 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3969 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3970 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3971 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003972 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3973 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3974 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3975
3976 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3977
3978
3979http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003980 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003982 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003983 Arguments :
3984 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3985 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003986 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003987 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3988 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3989 details on the supported keywords.
3990
3991 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3992 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3993 with the usual backslash ('\').
3994
3995 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3996 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3997 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3998 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3999 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4000
4001 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004002 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004003 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4004 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4005 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4006
4007 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004008 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004009 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4010 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4011 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4012 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4013
4014 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004015 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004016 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4017 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4018 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4019 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4020 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004021 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004022 trace).
4023
4024 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004025 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004026 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4027 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4028 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4029 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4030 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004031 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004032
4033 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4034 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4035 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4036 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4037 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4038 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4039 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4040 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4041
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004042 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4043 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4044 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4045
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004046 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4047 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4048
4049 Examples :
4050 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004051 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004052
4053 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004054 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004055
4056 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004057 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004058
4059 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004060 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004061
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004062 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004063
4064
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004065http-check send-state
4066 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4068 yes | no | yes | yes
4069 Arguments : none
4070
4071 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4072 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4073 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4074 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4075 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4076
4077 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4078 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4079 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4080 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4081 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004082 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4083 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4084 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4085
4086 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4087 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4088 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4089
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004090 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4091 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4092 checked in multiple backends.
4093
4094 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4095 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4096
4097 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4098 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4099 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4100 one fails.
4101
4102 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4103 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4104 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4105
4106 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4107 server's queue.
4108
4109 Example of a header received by the application server :
4110 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4111 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4112
4113 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4114
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004115
4116http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004117 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4118
4119 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4120 no | yes | yes | yes
4121
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004122 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4123 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4124 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4125 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4126 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004127
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004128 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4129 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004130
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004131 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004132
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004133 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4134 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4135 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4136 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004137
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004138 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4139 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4140 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4141 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004142
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004143 Example:
4144 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4145 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4146 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004147
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004148 http-request allow if nagios
4149 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4150 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4151 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004152
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004153 Example:
4154 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4155 acl add path /addacl
4156 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004157
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004158 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004159
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004160 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4161 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004162
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004163 Example:
4164 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4165 acl setmap path /setmap
4166 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004167
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004168 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004170 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4171 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004172
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004173 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4174 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004175
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004176http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004177
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004178 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4179 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4180 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4181 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4182 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4183 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4184 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4185 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004186
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004187http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004189 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4190 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4191 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4192 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4193 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4194 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4195 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4196 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004197
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004198http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004199
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004200 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4201 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004202
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004203
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004204http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004205
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004206 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4207 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4208 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4209 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4210 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004211
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004212 Example:
4213 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4214 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004215
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004216http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004217
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004218 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004219
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004220http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4221 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004222
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004223 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4224 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4225 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4226 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4227 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4228 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4229 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4230 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4231 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004233 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4234 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4235 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4236 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4237 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4238 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004240http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4243 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4244 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4245 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4246 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4247 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004248
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004249http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004250
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004251 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004252
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004253http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004254
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004255 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4256 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4257 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4258 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4259 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4260 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004262http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004263
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004264 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4265 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4266 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4267 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4268 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004269
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004270http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4271
4272 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4273 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4274 pointed by <resolvers>.
4275 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4276 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4277 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4278 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4279 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4280 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4281 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4282 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4283 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4284 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4285 to 0.0.0.0.
4286
4287 Example:
4288 resolvers mydns
4289 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4290 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4291 timeout retry 1s
4292 hold valid 10s
4293 hold nx 3s
4294 hold other 3s
4295 hold obsolete 0s
4296 accepted_payload_size 8192
4297
4298 frontend fe
4299 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4300 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4301 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4302
4303 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4304 # which mean DNS resolution error
4305 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4306
4307 default_backend be
4308
4309 backend b_503
4310 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4311 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4312 # 503 error page to end users
4313
4314 backend be
4315 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4316 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4317 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4318 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4319 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4320
4321 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4322 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4323
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004324http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4325
4326 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4327 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4328 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4329 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004330 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4331 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004332
4333 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004335http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004337 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4338 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4339 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4340 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4341 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004342
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004343http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004344
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004345 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4346 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4347 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4348 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004350http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4351 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004352
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004353 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4354 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4355 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4356 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4357 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4358 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4359 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4360 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004362 Example:
4363 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004365 # applied to:
4366 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004368 # outputs:
4369 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004371 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004373http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4374 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004376 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4377 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4378 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4379 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004380
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004381 Example:
4382 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384 # applied to:
4385 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004386
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004387 # outputs:
4388 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004389
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004390http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4391http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004392
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004393 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4394 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4395 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004397http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004398
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004399 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4400 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4401 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004403http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004405 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4406 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4407 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4408 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4409 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004410
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004411 Arguments:
4412 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4413 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004414
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004415 Example:
4416 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4417 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004418
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004419 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4420 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004421
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004422http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004424 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4425 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4426 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004427
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004428 Arguments:
4429 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4430 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004432 Example:
4433 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4434 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004436 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4437 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4438 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004439
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004440http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004442 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4443 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4444 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4445 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4446 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004447
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004448 Example:
4449 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4450 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4451 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4452 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4453 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4454 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4455 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4456 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4457 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004458
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004459http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004460
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004461 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4462 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4463 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4464 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4465 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004466
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004467http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4468 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004469
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004470 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4471 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4472 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4473 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4474 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4475 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4476 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4477 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4478 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004479
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004480http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004482 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4483 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4484 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4485 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4486 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4487 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4488 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004489
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004490http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004491
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004492 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4493 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4494 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004496http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004498 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4499 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4500 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4501 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4502 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4503 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4504 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4505 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004507http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004508
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004509 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4510 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4511 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4512 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4513 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4514 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004515
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004516 Example :
4517 # prepend the host name before the path
4518 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004520http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004521
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004522 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4523 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4524 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4525 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4526 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004527
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004528http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004530 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4531 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4532 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4533 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4534 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4535 values have higher priority.
4536 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4537 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4538 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4539 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4540 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004542http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004544 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4545 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4546 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4547 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4548 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4549 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4550 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004551
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004552 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004553
4554 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004555 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4556 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004557
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004558http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4559 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4560 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4561 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4562 privacy.
4563
4564 Arguments :
4565 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4566 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004567
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004568 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004569 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4570 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4571
4572 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4573 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4574
4575http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4576
4577 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4578 expression.
4579
4580 Arguments:
4581 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4582 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004583
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004584 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004585 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4586 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4587
4588 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4589 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4590 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4591
4592http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4593
4594 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4595 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4596 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4597 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4598 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4599 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4600 information from the request.
4601
4602 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4603
4604http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4605
4606 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4607 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4608 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4609 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4610 path and the query string.
4611 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4612
4613http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4614
4615 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4616 inline.
4617
4618 Arguments:
4619 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4620 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4621 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4622 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4623 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4624 (request and response)
4625 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4626 processing
4627 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4628 processing
4629 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4630 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4631 and '_'.
4632
4633 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4634 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004635
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004636 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004637 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004639http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4640 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004642 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4643 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4644 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4645 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4646 agent name must be used.
4647
4648 Arguments:
4649 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4650
4651 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4652 configuration.
4653
4654http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4655
4656 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4657 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4658 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4659 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4660 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4661 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4662 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4663 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4664 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4665 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4666 action.
4667 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4668 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4669 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4670 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4671 you fully understand how it works.
4672
4673http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4674
4675 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4676 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4677 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4678 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4679 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4680 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4681 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4682 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4683 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4684 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4685 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4686 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4687 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4688
4689http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4690http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4691http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4692
4693 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4694 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4695 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4696 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4697 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4698 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4699 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4700 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4701 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4702 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4703 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4704 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4705
4706 Arguments :
4707 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4708 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4709 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4710 select which table entry to update the counters.
4711
4712 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4713 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4714 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4715 that table until the session ends.
4716
4717 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4718 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4719 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4720 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4721 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4722 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4723 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4724 useful information.
4725
4726 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4727 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4728 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4729 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4730 checks that make use of it.
4731
4732http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4733
4734 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004735
4736 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004737 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004738
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004739http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004740
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004741 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4742 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4743 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004744
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004745
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004746http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004747 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4748
4749 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4750 no | yes | yes | yes
4751
4752 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4753 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4754 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4755 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4756 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4757 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4758
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004759 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4760 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004761
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004762 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004763
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004764 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4765 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4766 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4767 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004768
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004769 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4770 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4771 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4772 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004773
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004774 Example:
4775 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004776
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004777 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004778
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004779 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4780 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004781
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004782 Example:
4783 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004784
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004785 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004786
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004787 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4788 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004789
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004790 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4791 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004792
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004793http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004794
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004795 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4796 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4797 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4798 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4799 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4800 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4801 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4802 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004803
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004804http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004805
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004806 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4807 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4808 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4809 example, or to pass some internal information.
4810 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4811 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4812 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004813
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004814http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004815
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004816 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4817 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004818
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004819http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004820
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004821 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004822
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004823http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004824
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004825 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4826 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4827 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4828 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4829 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4830 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4831 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004832
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004833 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4834 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4835 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4836 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4837 keyword.
4838 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4839 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004840
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004841http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004842
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004843 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4844 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4845 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4846 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4847 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4848 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004849
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004850http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004851
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004852 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004853
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004854http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004855
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004856 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4857 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4858 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4859 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4860 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4861 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004862
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004863http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004864
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004865 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4866 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004867
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004868http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004869
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004870 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4871 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4872 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4873 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4874 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4875 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004876
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004877http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4878 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004879
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004880 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4881 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4882 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4883 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4884 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4885 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4886 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4887 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004888
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004889 Example:
4890 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004891
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004892 # applied to:
4893 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004894
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004895 # outputs:
4896 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004897
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004898 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004899
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004900http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4901 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004902
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004903 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4904 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4905 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4906 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004907
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004908 Example:
4909 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004910
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004911 # applied to:
4912 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004913
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004914 # outputs:
4915 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004916
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004917http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4918http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004919
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004920 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4921 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4922 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004923
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004924http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004925
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004926 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4927 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4928 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004929
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004930http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004931
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004932 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4933 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4934 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4935 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4936 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004937
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004938 Arguments:
4939 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004940
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004941 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4942 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004944http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004946 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4947 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4948 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004949
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004950http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4951
4952 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4953 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4954 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4955 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4956 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4957
4958http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4959
4960 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4961 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4962 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4963 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4964 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4965 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4966 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4967 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4968 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4969
4970http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4971
4972 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4973 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4974 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4975 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4976 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4977 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4978 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4979
4980http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4981
4982 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4983 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4984 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4985 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4986 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4987 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4988 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4989 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4990
4991http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4992 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4993
4994 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4995 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4996 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4997 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004998
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004999 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005000 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5001 http-response set-status 431
5002 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5003 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005004
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005005http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005006
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005007 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5008 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5009 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5010 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5011 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5012 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5013 based on some information from the request.
5014
5015 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5016
5017http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5018
5019 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5020 inline.
5021
5022 Arguments:
5023 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5024 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5025 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5026 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5027 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5028 (request and response)
5029 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5030 processing
5031 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5032 processing
5033 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5034 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5035 and '_'.
5036
5037 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5038 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005039
5040 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005041 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005042
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005043http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005044
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005045 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5046 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5047 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5048 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5049 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5050 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5051 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5052 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5053 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5054 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5055 action.
5056 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5057 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5058 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5059 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5060 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005062http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5063http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5064http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005065
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005066 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5067 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5068 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5069 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5070 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5071 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5072
5073http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5074
5075 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5076 about <var-name>.
5077
5078 Example:
5079 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5080
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005081
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005082http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5083 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5084
5085 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5086 yes | no | yes | yes
5087
5088 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005089 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5090 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5091 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005092
5093 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5094
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005095 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5096 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5097 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5098 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5099 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5100 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5101 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5102 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5103 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5104 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005105
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005106 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5107 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5108 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5109 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5110 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5111 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5112 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5113 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005114
5115 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5116 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5117 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5118 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5119 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5120 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5121 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5122 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
5123 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
5124 downsides of rare connection failures.
5125
5126 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5127 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5128 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5129 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5130 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5131 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005132 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005133 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5134 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5135 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5136 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5137 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5138
5139 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005140 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5141 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5142 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005143
5144 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005145 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005146
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005147 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5148 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005149
5150 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5151 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5152 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5153
5154 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5155 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5156 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5157
5158 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5159
5160
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005161http-send-name-header [<header>]
5162 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5163
5164 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5165 yes | no | yes | yes
5166
5167 Arguments :
5168
5169 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5170
5171 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005172 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005173 is added with the header string proved.
5174
5175 See also : "server"
5176
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005177id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005178 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5180 no | yes | yes | yes
5181 Arguments : none
5182
5183 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5184 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5185 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005186
5187
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005188ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5189 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5190 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005191 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005192
5193 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5194 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5195 and running).
5196
5197 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5198 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5199 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005200 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005201 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5202
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005203 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5204 "unless" condition is met.
5205
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005206 Example:
5207 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5208 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5209 ignore-persist if url_static
5210
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005211 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5212
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005213load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5214 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5215 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5216 yes | no | yes | yes
5217
5218 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5219 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5220 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005221 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005222 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5223 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5224 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5225 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5226
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005227 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005228 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005229 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005230
5231 Arguments:
5232 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5233 named "server-state-file".
5234
5235 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5236 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5237 name is used as a file name.
5238
5239 none don't load any stat for this backend
5240
5241 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005242 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5243 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5244 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005245 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005246 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005247
5248 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5249 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5250
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005251 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005252
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005253 global
5254 stats socket /tmp/socket
5255 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005256
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005257 defaults
5258 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005259
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005260 backend bk
5261 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5262 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005263
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005264
5265 Then one can run :
5266
5267 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5268
5269 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5270
5271 1
5272 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5273 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5274 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5275
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005276 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005277
5278 global
5279 stats socket /tmp/socket
5280 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5281
5282 defaults
5283 load-server-state-from-file local
5284
5285 backend bk
5286 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5287 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5288
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005289
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005290 Then one can run :
5291
5292 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5293
5294 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5295
5296 1
5297 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5298 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5299 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5300
5301 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5302 "show servers state"
5303
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005304
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005305log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005306log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005307no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005308 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5310 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005311
5312 Prefix :
5313 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5314 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5315 prefix does not allow arguments.
5316
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005317 Arguments :
5318 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5319 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5320 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5321 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5322 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5323 parameter.
5324
5325 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5326 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5327
5328 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5329 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5330 standard syslog port).
5331
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005332 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5333 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5334 standard syslog port).
5335
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005336 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5337 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5338 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005339 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005340
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005341 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5342 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5343 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5344 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5345 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5346 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5347 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5348 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5349 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5350 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5351 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5352 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5353 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5354 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5355 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5356 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005357 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5358 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005359
5360 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5361 and "fd@2", see above.
5362
5363 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5364 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005365
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005366 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5367 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5368 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5369 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5370 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5371 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5372 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5373 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5374 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5375 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005376 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005377
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005378 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5379 one of the following :
5380
5381 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5382 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5383
5384 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5385 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5386
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005387 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5388 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5389 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5390 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5391 systemd logger consumes.
5392
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005393 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5394 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5395 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5396 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5397
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005398 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5399
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005400 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5401 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5402 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5403
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005404 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5405 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5406 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5407 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005408
5409 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5410 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5411 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005412 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5413 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5414 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5415 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5416 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005417
5418 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5419
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005420 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5421 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5422 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005423
5424 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5425 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5426 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5427 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5428
5429 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5430 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005431
5432 Example :
5433 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005434 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5435 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5436 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005437 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5438 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005439 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005440
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005441
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005442log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005443 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5444 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5445 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005446
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005447 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5448 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5449 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5450 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5451 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005452
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005453 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5454 "option httplog" directives.
5455
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005456log-format-sd <string>
5457 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5458 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5459 yes | yes | yes | no
5460
5461 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5462 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5463 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5464 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5465 which covers the log format string in depth.
5466
5467 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5468 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5469
5470 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5471 log format to "rfc5424".
5472
5473 Example :
5474 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5475
5476
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005477log-tag <string>
5478 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5479 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5480 yes | yes | yes | yes
5481
5482 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5483 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5484 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5485 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5486 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5487 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5488 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5489 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5490 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005491
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005492max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5493 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5494 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5495 yes | no | yes | yes
5496
5497 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5498 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5499 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5500 servers.
5501
5502 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5503 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5504 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5505 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5506 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005507 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005508 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5509 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5510 picking a different server.
5511
5512 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5513 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5514 even if they have to be queued.
5515
5516 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5517 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5518
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005519max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5520 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5521 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5522 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005523
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005524maxconn <conns>
5525 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5527 yes | yes | yes | no
5528 Arguments :
5529 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5530 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5531 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5532 closes.
5533
5534 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5535 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5536 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5537 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005538 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5539 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5540 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5541 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005542
5543 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5544 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5545 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5546
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005547 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5548 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005549
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005550 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5551
5552
5553mode { tcp|http|health }
5554 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5556 yes | yes | yes | yes
5557 Arguments :
5558 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5559 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5560 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5561 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5562
5563 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5564 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5565 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5566 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5567 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5568
5569 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005570 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5571 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5572 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5573 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5574 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5575 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5576 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005577
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005578 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5579 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5580 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005581
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005582 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005583 defaults http_instances
5584 mode http
5585
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005586 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005587
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005588
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005589monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005590 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5592 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005593 Arguments :
5594 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5595 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005596 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005597 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5598 backend and its backup.
5599
5600 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5601 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5602 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5603 servers in a list of backends.
5604
5605 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5606 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5607 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5608 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5609 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5610 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5611 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005612 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5613 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005614
5615 Example:
5616 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005617 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005618 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5619 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5620 monitor-uri /site_alive
5621 monitor fail if site_dead
5622
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005623 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005624
5625
5626monitor-net <source>
5627 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5629 yes | yes | yes | no
5630 Arguments :
5631 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5632 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5633 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5634 followed by a mask.
5635
5636 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5637 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005638 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005639 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5640
5641 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5642 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5643 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5644 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005645 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5646 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5647 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005648
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005649 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5650 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5651 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5652 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5653 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5654 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005655
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005656 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5657 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005658
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005659 Example :
5660 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5661 frontend www
5662 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5663
5664 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5665
5666
5667monitor-uri <uri>
5668 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5670 yes | yes | yes | no
5671 Arguments :
5672 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5673 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5674
5675 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5676 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5677 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5678 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5679 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5680 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5681 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5682 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5683
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005684 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5685 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5686 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5687 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5688 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5689 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5690 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5691 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005692
5693 Example :
5694 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5695 frontend www
5696 mode http
5697 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5698
5699 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5700
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005701
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005702option abortonclose
5703no option abortonclose
5704 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5706 yes | no | yes | yes
5707 Arguments : none
5708
5709 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5710 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5711 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5712 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005713 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005714 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5715 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5716 encountered while delivering the response.
5717
5718 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5719 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5720 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5721 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5722 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5723 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005724 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005725 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005726 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005727 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5728 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5729 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5730
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005731 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5732 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005733 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5734 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5735 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5736 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5737 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5738 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005739 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005740
5741 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5742 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5743
5744 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5745
5746
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005747option accept-invalid-http-request
5748no option accept-invalid-http-request
5749 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5751 yes | yes | yes | no
5752 Arguments : none
5753
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005754 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005755 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005756 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005757 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5758 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5759 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5760 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5761 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005762 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5763 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5764 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5765 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005766 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005767 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005768 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5769 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5770 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005771
5772 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5773 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5774 been confirmed.
5775
5776 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5777 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005778 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5779 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005780 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5781
5782 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5783 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5784
5785 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5786 stats socket.
5787
5788
5789option accept-invalid-http-response
5790no option accept-invalid-http-response
5791 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5793 yes | no | yes | yes
5794 Arguments : none
5795
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005796 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005797 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005798 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005799 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5800 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5801 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5802 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5803 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005804 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5805 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5806 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005807
5808 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5809 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5810 been confirmed.
5811
5812 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5813 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5814 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5815 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5816
5817 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5818 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5819
5820 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5821 stats socket.
5822
5823
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005824option allbackups
5825no option allbackups
5826 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5828 yes | no | yes | yes
5829 Arguments : none
5830
5831 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5832 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5833 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5834 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5835 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5836 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5837 order between the backup servers anymore.
5838
5839 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5840 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5841
5842 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5843 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5844
5845
5846option checkcache
5847no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005848 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5850 yes | no | yes | yes
5851 Arguments : none
5852
5853 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5854 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005855 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005856 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5857 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005858 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005859
5860 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005861 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005862 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005863 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5864 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005865 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005866 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005867 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5868 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005869 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005870 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5871 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005872 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005873 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5874 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5875 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5876 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5877 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5878 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5879 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5880 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5881 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5882
5883 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005884 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005885 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005886 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005887 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5888
5889 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5890 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005891 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005892 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005893
5894 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5895 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5896
5897
5898option clitcpka
5899no option clitcpka
5900 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5902 yes | yes | yes | no
5903 Arguments : none
5904
5905 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5906 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005907 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005908 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5909
5910 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5911 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5912 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5913 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5914
5915 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5916 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5917 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5918 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5919 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5920
5921 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5922
5923 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5924 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5925 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5926
5927 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5928 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5929
5930 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5931
5932
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005933option contstats
5934 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5936 yes | yes | yes | no
5937 Arguments : none
5938
5939 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5940 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5941 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5942 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005943 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5944 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5945 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5946 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5947 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005948
5949
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005950option dontlog-normal
5951no option dontlog-normal
5952 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5954 yes | yes | yes | no
5955 Arguments : none
5956
5957 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5958 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5959 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5960 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5961 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5962 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5963 logged.
5964
5965 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5966 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5967 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005969 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005970 logging.
5971
5972
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005973option dontlognull
5974no option dontlognull
5975 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5977 yes | yes | yes | no
5978 Arguments : none
5979
5980 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5981 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5982 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5983 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5984 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5985 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005986 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5987 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5988 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005989
5990 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005991 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005992 would not be logged.
5993
5994 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5995 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5996
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005997 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5998 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005999
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006000
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006001option forceclose (deprecated)
6002no option forceclose (deprecated)
6003 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006004
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006005 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006006
6007
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006008option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006009 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6011 yes | yes | yes | yes
6012 Arguments :
6013 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6014 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006015 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006016 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006017
6018 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6019 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6020 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6021 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6022 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6023 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6024 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006025 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6026 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6027 possible that the client has already brought one.
6028
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006029 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006030 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006031 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006032 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006033 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006034 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006035
6036 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6037 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6038 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6039 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6040 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6041 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6042 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6043
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006044 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6045 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6046 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6047 are under the control of the end-user.
6048
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006049 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006050 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6051 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006052 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6053 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6054 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006055
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006056 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006057 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6058 frontend www
6059 mode http
6060 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6061
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006062 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6063 backend www
6064 mode http
6065 option forwardfor header X-Client
6066
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006067 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006068 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006069
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006070
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006071option http-buffer-request
6072no option http-buffer-request
6073 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6075 yes | yes | yes | yes
6076 Arguments : none
6077
6078 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6079 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6080 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6081 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6082 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6083 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6084 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6085 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006086 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006087 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6088 default.
6089
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006090 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006091
6092
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006093option http-ignore-probes
6094no option http-ignore-probes
6095 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6097 yes | yes | yes | no
6098 Arguments : none
6099
6100 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6101 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6102 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6103 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6104 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6105 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6106 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6107 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6108 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006109 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6110 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006111 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6112
6113 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6114 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6115 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6116 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6117 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6118 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6119 are often the only way to detect them.
6120
6121 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6122 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6123
6124 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6125
6126
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006127option http-keep-alive
6128no option http-keep-alive
6129 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6131 yes | yes | yes | yes
6132 Arguments : none
6133
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006134 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6135 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006136 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6137 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6138 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6139 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6140 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006141
6142 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6143 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006144 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6145 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6146 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6147 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6148 situations where this option may be useful :
6149
6150 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006151 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006152
6153 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6154 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6155
6156 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6157 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6158 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6159 request.
6160
6161 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6162 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006163 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6164 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6165 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006166
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006167 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6168 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6169 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6170 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6171 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6172 not set.
6173
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006174 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006175 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6176 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006177
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006178 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006179 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006180 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006181
6182
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006183option http-no-delay
6184no option http-no-delay
6185 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6187 yes | yes | yes | yes
6188 Arguments : none
6189
6190 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6191 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6192 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6193 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6194 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6195 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6196 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6197 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6198 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6199 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6200 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6201 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6202 affected.
6203
6204 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6205 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6206 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6207 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6208 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6209 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6210 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6211 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6212 latency environments.
6213
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006214 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6215
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006216
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006217option http-pretend-keepalive
6218no option http-pretend-keepalive
6219 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006221 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006222 Arguments : none
6223
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006224 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006225 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6226 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6227 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6228 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6229 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6230 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6231 consider the response complete.
6232
6233 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6234 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6235 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6236 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006237 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006238 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6239
6240 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6241 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6242 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6243 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6244 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6245 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6246 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6247
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006248 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6249 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6250 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6251 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6252 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6253 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006254
6255 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6256 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6257
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006258 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006259 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006260
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006261
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006262option http-server-close
6263no option http-server-close
6264 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6266 yes | yes | yes | yes
6267 Arguments : none
6268
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006269 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6270 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6271 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6272 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006273 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6274 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6275 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6276 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6277 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6278 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6279 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6280 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6281 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6282 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6283 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006284
6285 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6286 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6287 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6288 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006289 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6290 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006291
6292 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6293 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006294 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6295 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6296 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006297
6298 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6299 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6300
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006301 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6302 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006303
6304
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006305option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6306no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6307 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006309 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006310 Arguments : none
6311
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006312 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6313 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6314 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6315
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006316 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6317 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6318 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6319 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006320 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006321
6322 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006323 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006324 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6325 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6326 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6327 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6328 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6329 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6330 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006331
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006332 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6333 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6334 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6335 backend.
6336
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006337 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6338 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6339
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006340 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6341 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006342
6343
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006344option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006345no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006346 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6348 yes | yes | yes | no
6349 Arguments : none
6350
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006351 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006352 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6353 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6354 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6355 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6356 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6357 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6358
6359 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6360 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006361 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6362 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6363 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006364
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006365 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6366 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6367 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6368 front of an existing proxy.
6369
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006370 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6371
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006372 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006373
6374
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006375option http-use-htx
6376no option http-use-htx
6377 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6379 yes | yes | yes | yes
6380 Arguments : none
6381
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006382 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006383 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006384 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6385 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6386 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6387 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6388 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006389
6390 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6391 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6392 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6393 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006394 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6395 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6396 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6397 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006398
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006399 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6400 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6401 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6402 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6403 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006404
6405 See also : "mode http"
6406
6407
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006408option httpchk
6409option httpchk <uri>
6410option httpchk <method> <uri>
6411option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6412 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6414 yes | no | yes | yes
6415 Arguments :
6416 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6417 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6418 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6419 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6420 ones.
6421
6422 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6423 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6424 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6425
6426 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6427 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6428 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6429 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6430 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6431
6432 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6433 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6434 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6435 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6436 the lack of any response.
6437
6438 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6439
6440 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6441 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6442 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6443
6444 Examples :
6445 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6446 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6447 backend https_relay
6448 mode tcp
6449 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6450 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6451
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006452 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6453 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6454 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006455
6456
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006457option httpclose
6458no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006459 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6461 yes | yes | yes | yes
6462 Arguments : none
6463
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006464 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6465 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6466 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6467 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006468 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006469
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006470 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6471 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6472 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6473 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6474 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006475
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006476 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6477 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6478 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006479
6480 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6481 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006482 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006483 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6484 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6485 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006486
6487 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6488 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6489
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006490 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006491
6492
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006493option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006494 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006496 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006497 Arguments :
6498 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6499 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6500 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006501 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006502 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006503
6504 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6505 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6506 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6507 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6508 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6509 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6510 ports.
6511
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006512 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6513 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006514
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006515 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006517 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006518
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006519
6520option http_proxy
6521no option http_proxy
6522 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6524 yes | yes | yes | yes
6525 Arguments : none
6526
6527 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6528 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6529 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6530 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6531 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6532
6533 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6534 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006535 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6536 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006537
6538 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6539 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6540
6541 Example :
6542 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6543 backend direct_forward
6544 option httpclose
6545 option http_proxy
6546
6547 See also : "option httpclose"
6548
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006549
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006550option independent-streams
6551no option independent-streams
6552 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6554 yes | yes | yes | yes
6555 Arguments : none
6556
6557 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6558 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6559 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6560 receive data or not.
6561
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006562 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006563 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6564 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6565 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6566 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6567 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6568 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6569 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6570 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6571 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6572 socket buffers.
6573
6574 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6575 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6576 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6577 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6578 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6579
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006580 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006581 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6582 deprecated.
6583
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006584 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006585
6586
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006587option ldap-check
6588 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6590 yes | no | yes | yes
6591 Arguments : none
6592
6593 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6594 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6595 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6596 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6597
6598 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6599 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6600
6601 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6602 configure it.
6603
6604 Example :
6605 option ldap-check
6606
6607 See also : "option httpchk"
6608
6609
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006610option external-check
6611 Use external processes for server health checks
6612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6613 yes | no | yes | yes
6614
6615 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6616 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6617 command".
6618
6619 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6620
6621 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6622
6623
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006624option log-health-checks
6625no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006626 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6628 yes | no | yes | yes
6629 Arguments : none
6630
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006631 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6632 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6633 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006634
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006635 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6636 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6637 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6638 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6639 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6640
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006641 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006642 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006643
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006644 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6645 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6646 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006647
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006648
6649option log-separate-errors
6650no option log-separate-errors
6651 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6653 yes | yes | yes | no
6654 Arguments : none
6655
6656 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6657 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6658 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6659 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6660 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6661 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6662 provides very important information.
6663
6664 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6665 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6666 error logs.
6667
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006668 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006669 logging.
6670
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006671
6672option logasap
6673no option logasap
6674 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6676 yes | yes | yes | no
6677 Arguments : none
6678
6679 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6680 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6681 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6682 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6683 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6684 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6685 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006686 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006687 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6688 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6689
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006690 Examples :
6691 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6692 mode http
6693 option httplog
6694 option logasap
6695 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6696
6697 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6698 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6699 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6700 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006702 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006703 logging.
6704
6705
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006706option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006707 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6709 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006710 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006711 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6712 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006713 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006714
6715 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6716 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006717 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006718 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6719 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6720 in the MySQL table, like this :
6721
6722 USE mysql;
6723 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6724 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6725
6726 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006727 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006728 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6729 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6730 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6731 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6732 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6733 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6734 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6735
6736 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6737 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006738
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006739 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006740
6741 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6742 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6743 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6744 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006745 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6746 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006747
6748 See also: "option httpchk"
6749
6750
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006751option nolinger
6752no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006753 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006754 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6755 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006756 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006757
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006758 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006759 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6760 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6761 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6762 connections.
6763
6764 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6765 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6766 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6767 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6768 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6769 this too.
6770
6771 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6772 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6773 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6774
6775 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6776 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6777 for servers.
6778
6779 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6780 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6781
6782
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006783option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6784 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6786 yes | yes | yes | yes
6787 Arguments :
6788 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6789 matching <network>
6790 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6791 header name.
6792
6793 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6794 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6795 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6796 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6797 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6798 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6799 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6800 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6801 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6802 possible that the client has already brought one.
6803
6804 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6805 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6806 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6807 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6808 header and requires different one.
6809
6810 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6811 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6812 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6813 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6814 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6815 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6816 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6817
6818 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6819 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6820 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6821 both are defined.
6822
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006823 Examples :
6824 # Original Destination address
6825 frontend www
6826 mode http
6827 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6828
6829 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6830 backend www
6831 mode http
6832 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6833
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006834 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006835
6836
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006837option persist
6838no option persist
6839 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6840 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6841 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006842 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006843
6844 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6845 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6846 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6847 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6848 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6849 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6850 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6851 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6852 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6853 redirected to another valid server.
6854
6855 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6856 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6857
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006858 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006859
6860
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006861option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6862 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6864 yes | no | yes | yes
6865 Arguments :
6866 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6867 PostgreSQL server.
6868
6869 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6870 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6871 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6872 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6873
6874 See also: "option httpchk"
6875
6876
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006877option prefer-last-server
6878no option prefer-last-server
6879 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6880 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6881 yes | no | yes | yes
6882 Arguments : none
6883
6884 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6885 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6886 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6887 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6888 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6889 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6890 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6891 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6892 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006893 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6894 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006895 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6896 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6897 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006898 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6899 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6900 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006901
6902 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6903 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6904
6905 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6906
6907
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006908option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006909option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006910no option redispatch
6911 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6912 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6913 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006914 Arguments :
6915 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6916 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6917 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006918 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006919 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006920 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006921 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6922 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6923 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6924
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006925
6926 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6927 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6928 be able to access the service anymore.
6929
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006930 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6931 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006932
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006933 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006934 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6935 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006936
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006937 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6938 "redisp" keywords.
6939
6940 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6941 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6942
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006943 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006944
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006945
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006946option redis-check
6947 Use redis health checks for server testing
6948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6949 yes | no | yes | yes
6950 Arguments : none
6951
6952 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6953 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6954 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6955 find the "+PONG" response message.
6956
6957 Example :
6958 option redis-check
6959
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006960 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006961
6962
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006963option smtpchk
6964option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6965 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6967 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006968 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006969 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006970 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006971 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6972
6973 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6974 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6975 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6976
6977 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6978 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6979 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6980 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6981 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6982 dead server.
6983
6984 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6985 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006986 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006987 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6988
6989 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6990 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6991 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6992 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006993 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006994
6995 Example :
6996 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6997
6998 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6999
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007000
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007001option socket-stats
7002no option socket-stats
7003
7004 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7006 yes | yes | yes | no
7007
7008 Arguments : none
7009
7010
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007011option splice-auto
7012no option splice-auto
7013 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7015 yes | yes | yes | yes
7016 Arguments : none
7017
7018 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7019 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007020 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007021 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007022 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007023 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7024 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7025 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7026 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7027
7028 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7029 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7030 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7031 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7032 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7033 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7034 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7035 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7036 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7037 keyword.
7038
7039 Example :
7040 option splice-auto
7041
7042 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7043 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7044
7045 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7046 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7047
7048
7049option splice-request
7050no option splice-request
7051 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7053 yes | yes | yes | yes
7054 Arguments : none
7055
7056 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007057 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007058 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7059 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7060 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7061 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7062
7063 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7064
7065 Example :
7066 option splice-request
7067
7068 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7069 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7070
7071 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7072 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7073
7074
7075option splice-response
7076no option splice-response
7077 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7079 yes | yes | yes | yes
7080 Arguments : none
7081
7082 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007083 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007084 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7085 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7086 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7087 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7088
7089 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7090
7091 Example :
7092 option splice-response
7093
7094 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7095 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7096
7097 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7098 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7099
7100
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007101option spop-check
7102 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7104 no | no | no | yes
7105 Arguments : none
7106
7107 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7108 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7109 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7110 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7111
7112 Example :
7113 option spop-check
7114
7115 See also : "option httpchk"
7116
7117
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007118option srvtcpka
7119no option srvtcpka
7120 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7122 yes | no | yes | yes
7123 Arguments : none
7124
7125 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7126 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007127 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007128 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7129
7130 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7131 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7132 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7133 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7134
7135 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7136 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7137 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7138 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7139 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7140
7141 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7142
7143 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7144 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7145 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7146
7147 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7148 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7149
7150 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7151
7152
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007153option ssl-hello-chk
7154 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7156 yes | no | yes | yes
7157 Arguments : none
7158
7159 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7160 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7161 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7162 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7163 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7164 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7165 hello message.
7166
7167 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7168 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7169 messages, which is appreciable.
7170
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007171 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7172 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7173 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007174
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007175 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7176
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007177
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007178option tcp-check
7179 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7180 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7181 yes | no | yes | yes
7182
7183 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7184 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7185
7186 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7187 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7188 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7189
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007190 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007191 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7192 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7193 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7194 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7195 only.
7196
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007197 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007198 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7199 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7200 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7201 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7202
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007203 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007204 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7205 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007206 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007207 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7208 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7209 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7210 the respective protocols.
7211 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007212 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007213
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007214 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7215 script.
7216
7217 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7218 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7219 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7220 The "comment" is of course optional.
7221
7222
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007223 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007224 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007225 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007226 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007227
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007228 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007229 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007230 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007231
7232 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7233 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007234 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007235 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007236 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007237 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007238 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007239 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007240 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7241 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007242 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007243 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7244 tcp-check expect string +OK
7245
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007246 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007247 (send many headers before analyzing)
7248 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007249 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007250 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7251 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7252 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7253 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007254 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007255
7256
7257 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7258
7259
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007260option tcp-smart-accept
7261no option tcp-smart-accept
7262 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7264 yes | yes | yes | no
7265 Arguments : none
7266
7267 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7268 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7269 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7270 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7271 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7272 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7273
7274 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7275 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7276 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7277 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7278
7279 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7280 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7281 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007282 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007283
7284 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7285 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7286 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7287
7288 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7289 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7290 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7291
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007292 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7293
7294
7295option tcp-smart-connect
7296no option tcp-smart-connect
7297 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7299 yes | no | yes | yes
7300 Arguments : none
7301
7302 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7303 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7304 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7305 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7306 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7307
7308 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7309 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7310 complex.
7311
7312 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7313 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7314 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7315
7316 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7317 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7318
7319 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7320
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007321
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007322option tcpka
7323 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7325 yes | yes | yes | yes
7326 Arguments : none
7327
7328 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7329 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007330 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007331 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7332
7333 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7334 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7335 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7336 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7337
7338 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7339 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7340 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7341 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7342 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7343
7344 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7345
7346 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7347 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7348 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7349 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7350 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7351 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7352 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7353 backends.
7354
7355 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7356
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007357
7358option tcplog
7359 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007361 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007362 Arguments : none
7363
7364 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7365 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7366 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7367 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7368 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7369 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7370 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7371 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7372
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007373 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007375 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007376
7377
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007378option transparent
7379no option transparent
7380 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007382 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007383 Arguments : none
7384
7385 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7386 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7387 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7388 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7389 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7390 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7391 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7392 appropriate server.
7393
7394 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7395 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7396
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007397 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007398 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007399
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007400
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007401external-check command <command>
7402 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7404 yes | no | yes | yes
7405
7406 Arguments :
7407 <command> is the external command to run
7408
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007409 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7410
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007411 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007412
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007413 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7414 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7415 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7416 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7417 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7418 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007419
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007420 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7421
7422 Environment variables :
7423 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7424 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7425
7426 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7427
7428 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7429
7430 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7431 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7432 for a UNIX socket).
7433
7434 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7435
7436 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7437
7438 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7439
7440 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7441
7442 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7443
7444 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7445 socket).
7446
7447 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7448 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7449
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007450 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7451 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7452 failed.
7453
7454 Example :
7455 external-check command /bin/true
7456
7457 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7458
7459
7460external-check path <path>
7461 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7463 yes | no | yes | yes
7464
7465 Arguments :
7466 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7467
7468 The default path is "".
7469
7470 Example :
7471 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7472
7473 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7474 "external-check command"
7475
7476
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007477persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007478persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007479 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7481 yes | no | yes | yes
7482 Arguments :
7483 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007484 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7485 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007486
7487 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7488 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007489 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007490 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7491 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7492 forwarded to this server.
7493
7494 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7495 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7496 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007497 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007498 a single "listen" section.
7499
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007500 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7501 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7502 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7503
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007504 Example :
7505 listen tse-farm
7506 bind :3389
7507 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7508 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7509 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7510 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7511 persist rdp-cookie
7512 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007513 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007514 balance rdp-cookie
7515 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7516 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7517
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007518 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7519 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007520
7521
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007522rate-limit sessions <rate>
7523 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7525 yes | yes | yes | no
7526 Arguments :
7527 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7528 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7529
7530 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7531 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7532 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7533 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7534 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7535 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7536
7537 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7538 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7539 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7540 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7541
7542 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7543 listen smtp
7544 mode tcp
7545 bind :25
7546 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007547 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007548
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007549 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7550 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7551 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007552
7553 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7554
7555
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007556redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7557redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7558redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007559 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7561 no | yes | yes | yes
7562
7563 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007564 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007565
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007566 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007567 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007568 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7569 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7570 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007571
7572 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7573 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7574 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7575 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7576 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007577 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7578 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7579 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7580 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007581
7582 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7583 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7584 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7585 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7586 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7587 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007588 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007589 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007590 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7591 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7592 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007593
7594 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007595 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7596 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7597 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007598 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007599 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7600 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7601 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7602 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007603
7604 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007605 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007606
7607 - "drop-query"
7608 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7609 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7610 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7611 with a location-type redirect.
7612
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007613 - "append-slash"
7614 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7615 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7616 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7617 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7618
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007619 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7620 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7621 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7622 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7623 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7624 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7625 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7626
7627 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7628 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7629 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7630 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7631 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7632 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7633 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007634
7635 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7636 acl clear dst_port 80
7637 acl secure dst_port 8080
7638 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007639 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007640 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007641 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7642
7643 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007644 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7645 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7646 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007647 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007648
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007649 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7650 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7651 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7652
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007653 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007654 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007655
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007656 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007657 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7658 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7659 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007661 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007662
7663
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007664redisp (deprecated)
7665redispatch (deprecated)
7666 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7667 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7668 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007669 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007670
7671 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7672 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7673 be able to access the service anymore.
7674
7675 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7676 redistribute them to a working server.
7677
7678 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7679 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7680 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007682 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7683 "option redispatch" instead.
7684
7685 See also : "option redispatch"
7686
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007687
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007688reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007689 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7691 no | yes | yes | yes
7692 Arguments :
7693 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7694 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007695 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007696
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007697 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7698 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7699
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007700 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7701 the last header of an HTTP request.
7702
7703 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7704 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7705 responses.
7706
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007707 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7708 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7709 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7710
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007711 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7712 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007713
7714
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007715reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7716reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007717 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7719 no | yes | yes | yes
7720 Arguments :
7721 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7722 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7723 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7724 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7725 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7726 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7727 ignores case.
7728
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007729 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7730 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7731
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007732 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7733 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7734 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7735 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007736 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007737
7738 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7739 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7740
7741 Example :
7742 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7743 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7744 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7745
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007746 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7747 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007748
7749
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007750reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7751reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007752 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7754 no | yes | yes | yes
7755 Arguments :
7756 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7757 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7758 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7759 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7760 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7761 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7762
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007763 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7764 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7765
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007766 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7767 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7768 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7769 next servers.
7770
7771 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7772 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7773 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7774
7775 Example :
7776 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7777 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7778 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7779
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007780 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7781 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007782
7783
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007784reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7785reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007786 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7788 no | yes | yes | yes
7789 Arguments :
7790 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7791 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7792 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7793 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7794 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7795 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7796 case.
7797
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007798 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7799 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7800
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007801 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7802 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7803 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7804 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007805 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007806
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007807 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007808 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007809 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007810
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007811 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7812 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7813
7814 Example :
7815 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7816 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7817 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7818
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007819 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7820 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007821
7822
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007823reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7824reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007825 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7827 no | yes | yes | yes
7828 Arguments :
7829 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7830 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7831 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7832 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7833 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7834 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7835 case.
7836
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007837 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7838 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7839
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007840 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7841 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7842 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7843 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7844
7845 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7846 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7847
7848 Example :
7849 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7850 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7851 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7852 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7853
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007854 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7855 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007856
7857
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007858reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7859reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007860 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7862 no | yes | yes | yes
7863 Arguments :
7864 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7865 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7866 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7867 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7868 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7869 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7870
7871 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7872 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7873 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7874 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007875 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007876
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007877 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7878 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7879
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007880 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7881 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7882 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7883
7884 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7885 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7886 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7887 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7888 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7889
7890 Example :
7891 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007892 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007893 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7894 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7895
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007896 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7897 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007898
7899
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007900reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7901reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007902 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7904 no | yes | yes | yes
7905 Arguments :
7906 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7907 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7908 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7909 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7910 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7911 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7912 ignores case.
7913
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007914 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7915 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7916
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007917 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7918 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007919 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7920 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7921 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007922 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7923 not set.
7924
7925 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7926 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7927 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7928 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7929 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7930
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007931 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007932 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007933 # block all others.
7934 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7935 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7936
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007937 # block bad guys
7938 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7939 reqitarpit . if badguys
7940
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007941 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7942 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007943
7944
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007945retries <value>
7946 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7947 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7948 yes | no | yes | yes
7949 Arguments :
7950 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7951 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7952 default value is 3.
7953
7954 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7955 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7956 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7957
7958 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007959 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7960 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007961
7962 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7963 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7964
7965 See also : "option redispatch"
7966
7967
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007968rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007969 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7971 no | yes | yes | yes
7972 Arguments :
7973 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7974 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007975 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007976
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007977 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7978 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7979
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007980 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7981 the last header of an HTTP response.
7982
7983 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7984 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7985 responses.
7986
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007987 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7988 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007989
7990
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007991rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7992rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007993 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7995 no | yes | yes | yes
7996 Arguments :
7997 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7998 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7999 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8000 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8001 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8002 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8003 ignores case.
8004
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008005 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8006 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8007
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008008 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8009 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008010 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008011 client.
8012
8013 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8014 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8015 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8016
8017 Example :
8018 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008019 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008020
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008021 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8022 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008023
8024
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008025rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8026rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008027 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8029 no | yes | yes | yes
8030 Arguments :
8031 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8032 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8033 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8034 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8035 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8036 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8037 ignores case.
8038
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008039 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8040 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8041
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008042 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8043 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8044 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8045 case-sensitive.
8046
8047 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008048 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8049 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8050 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008051
8052 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8053 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8054
8055 Example :
8056 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8057 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8058
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008059 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8060 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008061
8062
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008063rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8064rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008065 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8067 no | yes | yes | yes
8068 Arguments :
8069 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8070 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8071 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8072 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8073 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8074 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8075 ignores case.
8076
8077 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8078 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8079 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8080 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008081 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008082
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008083 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8084 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8085
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008086 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8087 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8088 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8089
8090 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8091 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8092 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8093 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8094 are not case-sensitive.
8095
8096 Example :
8097 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8098 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8099
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008100 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8101 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008102
8103
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008104server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008105 Declare a server in a backend
8106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8107 no | no | yes | yes
8108 Arguments :
8109 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008110 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008111 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008112
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008113 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8114 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8115 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8116 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008117 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8118 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8119 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8120 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8121 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008122 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8123 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8124 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8125 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8126 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8127 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8128 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008129 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008130 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8131 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8132 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8133 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8134 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8135 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008136 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8137 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008138 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8139 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008140
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008141 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008142 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8143 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8144 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8145 adding this value to the client's port.
8146
8147 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8148 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008149 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008150
8151 Examples :
8152 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8153 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008154 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008155 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8156 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8157 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008158
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008159 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8160 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8161 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8162 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8163 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8164
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008165 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8166 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008167
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008168server-state-file-name [<file>]
8169 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8170 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8171 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8172 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8173 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8174 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8175
8176 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8177 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8178
8179 global
8180 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8181
8182 backend bk
8183 load-server-state-from-file
8184
8185 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8186 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008187
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008188server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8189 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8190 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8192 no | no | yes | yes
8193
8194 Arguments:
8195 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8196
8197 <num | range>
8198 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8199 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8200 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8201 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8202
8203 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8204
8205 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8206
8207 <params*>
8208 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8209 keyword.
8210
8211 Examples:
8212 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8213 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8214 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8215
8216 # or
8217 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8218
8219 # would be equivalent to:
8220 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8221 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8222 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8223
8224
8225
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008226source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008227source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008228source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008229 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8231 yes | no | yes | yes
8232 Arguments :
8233 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8234 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008235
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008236 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008237 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8238 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8239 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8240 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8241 supported prefixes are :
8242 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8243 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8244 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008245 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008246 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8247 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008248
8249 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8250 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008251 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8252 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8253 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008254
8255 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8256 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8257 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8258 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8259 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8260 <addr>.
8261
8262 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8263 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8264 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8265 port.
8266
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008267 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8268 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8269 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8270 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008271 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008272 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8273 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8274 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8275 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8276 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8277 HTTP header.
8278
8279 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8280 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008281 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008282 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8283 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8284 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8285 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8286 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8287 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8288 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8289
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008290 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8291 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8292 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8293 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8294 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8295 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8296
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008297 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8298 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8299 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8300 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8301
8302 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8303 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8304 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8305 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8306 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8307 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8308
8309 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8310 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8311 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8312 there are two methods :
8313
8314 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8315 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8316 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8317 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8318 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8319 of the client ranges may be used.
8320
8321 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8322 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8323 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8324 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8325 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8326 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8327 same session.
8328
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008329 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8330 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8331 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008332 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008333
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008334 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8335
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008336 Examples :
8337 backend private
8338 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8339 source 192.168.1.200
8340
8341 backend transparent_ssl1
8342 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8343 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8344
8345 backend transparent_ssl2
8346 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8347 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8348 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8349
8350 backend transparent_ssl3
8351 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8352 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8353 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8354
8355 backend transparent_smtp
8356 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8357 # with Tproxy version 4.
8358 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8359
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008360 backend transparent_http
8361 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8362 # proxy.
8363 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8364
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008365 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008366 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008368
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008369srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8370 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8372 yes | no | yes | yes
8373 Arguments :
8374 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8375 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8376 as explained at the top of this document.
8377
8378 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8379 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8380 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8381 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8382 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8383 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8384 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8385
8386 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8387 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8388 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8389 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8390 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008391 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008392 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008393 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008394
8395 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8396 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8397 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8398 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8399 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8400 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8401
8402 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8403 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8404
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008405 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8406 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008407
8408
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008409stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8410 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008412 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008413
8414 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8415 matched.
8416
8417 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8418 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8419
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008420 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8421 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008422 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008423
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008424 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8425 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8426 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8427 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008428
8429 Example :
8430 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8431 backend stats_localhost
8432 stats enable
8433 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8434
8435 Example :
8436 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8437 backend stats_auth
8438 stats enable
8439 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8440 stats admin if TRUE
8441
8442 Example :
8443 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8444 userlist stats-auth
8445 group admin users admin
8446 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8447 group readonly users haproxy
8448 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8449
8450 backend stats_auth
8451 stats enable
8452 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8453 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8454 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8455 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8456
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008457 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8458 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8459 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008460
8461
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008462stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8463 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008465 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008466 Arguments :
8467 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8468
8469 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8470
8471 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8472 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8473 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8474 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8475 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8476 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8477
8478 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8479 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8480 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008481 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008482
8483 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8484 report using "stats scope".
8485
8486 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8487 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8488 unobvious parameters.
8489
8490 Example :
8491 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8492 backend public_www
8493 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8494 stats enable
8495 stats hide-version
8496 stats scope .
8497 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008498 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008499 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8500 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8501
8502 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8503 backend private_monitoring
8504 stats enable
8505 stats uri /admin?stats
8506 stats refresh 5s
8507
8508 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8509
8510
8511stats enable
8512 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008514 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008515 Arguments : none
8516
8517 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8518 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8519 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8520 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8521 - stats auth : no authentication
8522 - stats scope : no restriction
8523
8524 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8525 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8526 unobvious parameters.
8527
8528 Example :
8529 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8530 backend public_www
8531 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8532 stats enable
8533 stats hide-version
8534 stats scope .
8535 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008536 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008537 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8538 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8539
8540 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8541 backend private_monitoring
8542 stats enable
8543 stats uri /admin?stats
8544 stats refresh 5s
8545
8546 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8547
8548
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008549stats hide-version
8550 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008552 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008553 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008554
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008555 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8556 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8557 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8558 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8559 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8560 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008561
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008562 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8563 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8564 unobvious parameters.
8565
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008566 Example :
8567 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8568 backend public_www
8569 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008570 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008571 stats hide-version
8572 stats scope .
8573 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008574 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008575 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8576 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008577
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008578 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8579 backend private_monitoring
8580 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008581 stats uri /admin?stats
8582 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008583
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008584 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008585
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008586
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008587stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8588 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8589 Access control for statistics
8590
8591 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8592 no | no | yes | yes
8593
8594 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8595 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8596 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8597 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8598 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8599 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8600
8601 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8602 instance.
8603
8604 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8605 about ACL usage.
8606
8607
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008608stats realm <realm>
8609 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008611 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008612 Arguments :
8613 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8614 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8615 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8616
8617 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8618 using a backslash ('\').
8619
8620 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8621 only related to authentication.
8622
8623 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8624 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8625 unobvious parameters.
8626
8627 Example :
8628 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8629 backend public_www
8630 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8631 stats enable
8632 stats hide-version
8633 stats scope .
8634 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008635 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008636 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8637 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8638
8639 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8640 backend private_monitoring
8641 stats enable
8642 stats uri /admin?stats
8643 stats refresh 5s
8644
8645 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8646
8647
8648stats refresh <delay>
8649 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008651 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008652 Arguments :
8653 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8654 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8655 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8656 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8657 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8658 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8659
8660 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8661 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8662 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8663 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8664
8665 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8666 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8667 unobvious parameters.
8668
8669 Example :
8670 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8671 backend public_www
8672 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8673 stats enable
8674 stats hide-version
8675 stats scope .
8676 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008677 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008678 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8679 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8680
8681 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8682 backend private_monitoring
8683 stats enable
8684 stats uri /admin?stats
8685 stats refresh 5s
8686
8687 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8688
8689
8690stats scope { <name> | "." }
8691 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008693 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008694 Arguments :
8695 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8696 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8697 section in which the statement appears.
8698
8699 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8700 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8701 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8702 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8703 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8704 exists.
8705
8706 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8707 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8708 unobvious parameters.
8709
8710 Example :
8711 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8712 backend public_www
8713 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8714 stats enable
8715 stats hide-version
8716 stats scope .
8717 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008718 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008719 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8720 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8721
8722 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8723 backend private_monitoring
8724 stats enable
8725 stats uri /admin?stats
8726 stats refresh 5s
8727
8728 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8729
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008730
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008731stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008732 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008734 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008735
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008736 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008737 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8738
8739 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8740 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8741
8742 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8743 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008744 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008745
8746 Example :
8747 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8748 backend private_monitoring
8749 stats enable
8750 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8751 stats uri /admin?stats
8752 stats refresh 5s
8753
8754 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8755 global section.
8756
8757
8758stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008759 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8761 yes | yes | yes | yes
8762 Arguments : none
8763
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008764 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008765 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8766 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8767 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8768 - IP (socket, server)
8769 - cookie (backend, server)
8770
8771 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8772 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008773 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008774
8775 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8776
8777
8778stats show-node [ <name> ]
8779 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008781 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008782 Arguments:
8783 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8784 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8785
8786 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8787 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008788 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008789
8790 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8791 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8792 unobvious parameters.
8793
8794 Example:
8795 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8796 backend private_monitoring
8797 stats enable
8798 stats show-node Europe-1
8799 stats uri /admin?stats
8800 stats refresh 5s
8801
8802 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8803 section.
8804
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008805
8806stats uri <prefix>
8807 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008809 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008810 Arguments :
8811 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8812 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8813 query string.
8814
8815 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8816 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8817 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8818 possible to reach it in the application.
8819
8820 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008821 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008822 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8823 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8824 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8825 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8826
8827 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8828 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8829 an address or a port to statistics only.
8830
8831 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8832 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8833 unobvious parameters.
8834
8835 Example :
8836 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8837 backend public_www
8838 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8839 stats enable
8840 stats hide-version
8841 stats scope .
8842 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008843 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008844 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8845 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8846
8847 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8848 backend private_monitoring
8849 stats enable
8850 stats uri /admin?stats
8851 stats refresh 5s
8852
8853 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8854
8855
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008856stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8857 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008859 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008860
8861 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008862 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008863 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008864 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008865 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8866
8867 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8868 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8869 the "stick-table" statement.
8870
8871 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8872 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8873 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8874 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8875 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8876
8877 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8878 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8879 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8880 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8881 transformation rules.
8882
8883 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8884 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8885 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8886 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8887 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8888 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8889 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8890
8891 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8892 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8893 ACL based conditions.
8894
8895 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8896 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8897 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8898 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8899
8900 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8901 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8902 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8903 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8904
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008905 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8906 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008907 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008908
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008909 Example :
8910 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8911 # last 30 minutes
8912 backend pop
8913 mode tcp
8914 balance roundrobin
8915 stick store-request src
8916 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8917 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8918 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8919
8920 backend smtp
8921 mode tcp
8922 balance roundrobin
8923 stick match src table pop
8924 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8925 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8926
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008927 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008928 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008929
8930
8931stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8932 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8934 no | no | yes | yes
8935
8936 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8937 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8938 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8939 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8940
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008941 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8942 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008943 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008944
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008945 Examples :
8946 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008947 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008948
8949 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8950 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8951 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8952
8953
8954 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8955 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8956 backend http
8957 mode http
8958 balance roundrobin
8959 stick on src table https
8960 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8961 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8962 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8963
8964 backend https
8965 mode tcp
8966 balance roundrobin
8967 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8968 stick on src
8969 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8970 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8971
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008972 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008973
8974
8975stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8976 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8978 no | no | yes | yes
8979
8980 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008981 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008982 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008983 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008984 server is selected.
8985
8986 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8987 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8988 the "stick-table" statement.
8989
8990 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8991 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8992 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8993 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8994 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8995 address.
8996
8997 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8998 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8999 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9000 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9001 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9002 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9003 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9004 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9005 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9006 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9007
9008 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9009 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9010 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9011 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9012 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9013 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9014 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9015
9016 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9017 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9018 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9019 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9020
9021 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9022 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9023 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9024 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9025 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9026 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009027 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9028 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9029 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9030 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9031 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9032 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009033
9034 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9035 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9036 the request.
9037
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009038 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9039 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009040 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009041
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009042 Example :
9043 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9044 # last 30 minutes
9045 backend pop
9046 mode tcp
9047 balance roundrobin
9048 stick store-request src
9049 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9050 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9051 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9052
9053 backend smtp
9054 mode tcp
9055 balance roundrobin
9056 stick match src table pop
9057 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9058 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9059
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009060 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009061 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009062
9063
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009064stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009065 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9066 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009067 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009069 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009070
9071 Arguments :
9072 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9073 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9074 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9075 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9076
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009077 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9078 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9079 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9080 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9081
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009082 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9083 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9084 instance.
9085
9086 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9087 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9088 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9089 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9090 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9091 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009092 to 32 characters.
9093
9094 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9095 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9096 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009097 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009098 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9099 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009100
9101 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009102 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9103 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009104 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9105 increase.
9106
9107 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009108 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9109 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9110 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009111
9112 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9113 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9114 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9115 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009116 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009117 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9118 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9119 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9120 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9121 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9122 parameter (see below).
9123
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009124 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9125 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9126 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9127 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9128 soft restart.
9129
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009130 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9131 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009132
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009133 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9134 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9135 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9136 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009137 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009138 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009139 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9140 if not expiration delay is specified.
9141
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009142 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9143 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9144 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9145 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009146 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9147 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9148 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9149 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9150 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9151 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9152 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9153 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9154 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9155 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9156 types and their arguments.
9157
9158 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9159 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9160 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9161 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9162
9163 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9164 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9165 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009166 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009167
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009168 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9169 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9170 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009171 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009172 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009173 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009174
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009175 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9176 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9177 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9178 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9179
9180 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9181 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9182 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9183 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9184 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9185 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9186
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009187 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9188 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9189 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9190 they were received.
9191
9192 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9193 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9194 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9195 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9196 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9197
9198 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9199 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9200 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9201 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9202 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9203
9204 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9205 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9206 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9207
9208 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9209 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9210 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9211 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9212 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9213
9214 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9215 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9216 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9217 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9218 the client side.
9219
9220 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9221 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9222 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9223 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9224 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9225 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9226 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9227
9228 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9229 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9230 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9231 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9232 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9233 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009234 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009235
9236 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9237 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9238 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9239 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9240 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9241 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9242
9243 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009244 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009245 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9246 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9247
9248 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9249 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9250 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9251 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9252 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9253 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9254 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9255 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9256 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9257 recommended for better fairness.
9258
9259 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009260 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009261 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9262 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9263
9264 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9265 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9266 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9267 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9268 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9269 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9270 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9271 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9272 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9273 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009274
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009275 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9276 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009277 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9278 reference it.
9279
9280 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9281 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009282 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9283 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9284 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009285
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009286 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9287 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9288 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9289 something that can be ignored.
9290
9291 Example:
9292 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9293 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9294 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9295 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9296
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009297 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009298 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009299
9300
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009301stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009302 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9304 no | no | yes | yes
9305
9306 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009307 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009308 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009309 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009310 server is selected.
9311
9312 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9313 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9314 the "stick-table" statement.
9315
9316 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9317 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9318 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9319 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9320
9321 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9322 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9323 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9324 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9325 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9326 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009327 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009328 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9329 rules.
9330
9331 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9332 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9333 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9334 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9335 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9336 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9337 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9338
9339 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9340 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9341 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9342 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9343
9344 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9345 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9346 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9347 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9348 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9349 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009350 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9351 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9352 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9353 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9354 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9355 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9356 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9357 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9358 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009359
9360 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9361
9362 Example :
9363 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9364 backend https
9365 mode tcp
9366 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009367 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009368 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009369
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009370 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9371 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9372
9373 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9374 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9375 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9376
9377 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9378 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009379
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009380 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9381 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9382 # at offset 44.
9383
9384 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9385 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9386
9387 # Learn on response if server hello.
9388 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009389
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009390 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9391 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9392
9393 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9394 extraction.
9395
9396
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009397tcp-check connect [params*]
9398 Opens a new connection
9399 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9400 no | no | yes | yes
9401
9402 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9403 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9404 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9405
9406 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9407 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9408 of the sequence.
9409
9410 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9411 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9412 do.
9413
9414 Parameters :
9415 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9416 use the TCP connection.
9417
9418 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9419 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9420 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9421
9422 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9423
9424 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9425
9426 Examples:
9427 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9428 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9429 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9430 option tcp-check
9431 tcp-check connect
9432 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9433 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9434 tcp-check send \r\n
9435 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9436 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9437 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9438 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9439 tcp-check send \r\n
9440 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9441 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9442
9443 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9444 option tcp-check
9445 tcp-check connect port 110
9446 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9447 tcp-check connect port 143
9448 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9449 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9450
9451 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9452
9453
9454tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009455 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009456 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9457 no | no | yes | yes
9458
9459 Arguments :
9460 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9461 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9462 binary.
9463 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9464 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9465 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9466
9467 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9468 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9469 with the usual backslash ('\').
9470 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009471 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009472 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9473 used upper or lower case.
9474
9475
9476 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9477
9478 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9479 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9480 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9481 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9482 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9483 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9484 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9485 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9486
9487 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9488 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9489 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9490 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9491 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9492 expression.
9493
9494 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9495 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9496 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9497 this exact hexadecimal string.
9498 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9499
9500 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9501 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9502 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9503 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9504 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9505 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9506 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9507 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9508 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9509 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9510 the null character.
9511
9512 Examples :
9513 # perform a POP check
9514 option tcp-check
9515 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9516
9517 # perform an IMAP check
9518 option tcp-check
9519 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9520
9521 # look for the redis master server
9522 option tcp-check
9523 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009524 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009525 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9526 tcp-check expect string role:master
9527 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9528 tcp-check expect string +OK
9529
9530
9531 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9532 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9533
9534
9535tcp-check send <data>
9536 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9537 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9538 no | no | yes | yes
9539
9540 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9541 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9542
9543 Examples :
9544 # look for the redis master server
9545 option tcp-check
9546 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9547 tcp-check expect string role:master
9548
9549 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9550 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9551
9552
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009553tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9554 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009555 tcp health check
9556 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9557 no | no | yes | yes
9558
9559 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9560 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009561 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009562 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9563 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9564 hexadecimal string.
9565 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9566
9567 Examples :
9568 # redis check in binary
9569 option tcp-check
9570 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9571 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9572
9573
9574 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9575 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9576
9577
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009578tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9579 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9581 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009582 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009583 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9584 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009585
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009586 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009587
9588 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9589 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009590 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9591 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9592 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9593 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9594 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9595 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009596
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009597 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9598 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9599 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9600 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009601
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009602 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009603 - accept :
9604 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9605 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9606 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009607
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009608 - reject :
9609 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9610 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9611 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9612 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9613 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9614 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9615 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9616 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9617 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9618 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9619 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009620 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009621
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009622 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9623 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9624 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9625 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9626 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9627 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9628 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9629 hosts.
9630
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009631 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9632 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9633 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9634 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9635 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9636 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9637 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9638 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9639
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009640 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9641 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9642 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9643 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9644 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9645 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9646 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9647 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9648 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009649 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9650 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009651
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009652 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009653 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009654 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9655 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9656 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9657 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9658 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9659 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9660 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9661 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9662 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9663 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9664 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9665 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009666
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009667 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009668 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009669 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009670 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009671 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9672 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9673 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009674
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009675 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9676 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9677 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9678 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009679
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009680 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9681 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9682 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9683 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9684 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009685 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9686 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9687 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9688 layer7 information is extracted.
9689
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009690 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9691 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9692 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9693 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9694 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009695
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009696 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9697 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9698 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9699 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9700
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009701 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9702 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9703 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9704 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9705
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009706 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9707 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9708 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9709 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9710 continues.
9711
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009712 - set-src <expr> :
9713 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9714 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9715 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009716 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009717
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009718 Arguments:
9719 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9720 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009721
9722 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009723 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9724
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009725 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9726 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009727
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009728 - set-src-port <expr> :
9729 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9730 expression.
9731
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009732 Arguments:
9733 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9734 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009735
9736 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009737 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9738
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009739 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9740 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9741 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009742
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009743 - set-dst <expr> :
9744 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9745 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9746 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9747 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9748 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9749
9750 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9751 followed by some converters.
9752
9753 Example:
9754
9755 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9756 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9757
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009758 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9759 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9760
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009761 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9762 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9763 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9764 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9765
9766
9767 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9768 followed by some converters.
9769
9770 Example:
9771
9772 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9773
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009774 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9775 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9776 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9777
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009778 - "silent-drop" :
9779 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009780 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009781 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9782 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9783 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9784 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9785 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009786 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9787 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009788 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9789 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009790 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009791 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9792 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9793 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9794 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9795
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009796 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9797 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9798 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009799
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009800 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9801 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9802 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009803
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009804 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009805 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009806 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009807
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009808 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9809 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9810 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009811
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009812 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009813 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9814 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009815
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009816 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9817
9818 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9819
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009820 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9821
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009822 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009823
9824
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009825tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9826 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009828 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009829 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009830 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9831 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009832
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009833 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009834
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009835 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009836 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9837 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9838 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9839 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009840
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009841 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9842 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9843 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9844 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009845 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9846 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9847 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9848 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9849 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9850 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009851 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009852 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009853
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009854 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9855 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9856 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9857 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009858
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009859 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009860 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009861 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009862 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9863 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009864 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009865 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009866 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009867 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009868 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009869 - set-dst <expr>
9870 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009871 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009872 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009873 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009874 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009875
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009876 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9877 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009878 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9879 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009880
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009881 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9882 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9883 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9884 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9885 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9886 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009887
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009888 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009889 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9890 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009891
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009892 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009893 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9894 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9895 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9896 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009897 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9898 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9899 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009900
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009901 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009902 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9903 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9904 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009905
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009906 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9907 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9908
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009909 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009910 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9911 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009912
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009913 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9914 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009915 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009916 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9917 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009918 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009919 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009920 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009921 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9922 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009923 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009924 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9925 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009926
9927 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9928 followed by some converters.
9929
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009930 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9931 <var-name>.
9932
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009933 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9934 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9935 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9936 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9937 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9938
9939 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9940 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9941 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9942 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9943 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9944 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9945 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9946 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9947 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9948 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9949 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9950
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009951 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9952 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9953 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9954 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9955 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9956
9957 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9958
9959 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9960
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009961 Example:
9962
9963 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009964 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009965
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009966 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009967 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9968 # and reject everything else.
9969 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9970 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009971 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009972 tcp-request content reject
9973
9974 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009975 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9976 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9977 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009978 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009979
9980 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9981 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9982 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009983 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009984 tcp-request content reject
9985
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009986 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009987 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009988 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009989 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009990 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9991 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009992
9993 Example:
9994 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9995 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009996 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009997
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009998 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009999 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010000
10001 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010002 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010003 # protecting all our sites
10004 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010005 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10006 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010007 ...
10008 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10009
10010 backend http_dynamic
10011 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010012 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010013 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010014 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010015 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010016 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010017 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010019 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010020
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010021 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10022 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010023
10024
10025tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10026 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010028 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010029 Arguments :
10030 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10031 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10032 as explained at the top of this document.
10033
10034 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10035 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10036 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10037 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10038 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10039
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010040 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10041 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10042 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10043 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10044
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010045 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10046 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010047 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010048 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010049 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10050 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10051 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10052 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010053
10054 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10055 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10056 it pass through unaffected.
10057
10058 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10059 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10060 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010061 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010062 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10063 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010064 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10065 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10066 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010067
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010068 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010069 "timeout client".
10070
10071
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010072tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10073 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10075 no | no | yes | yes
10076 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010077 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10078 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010079
10080 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10081
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010082 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010083 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10084 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010085 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10086 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010087
10088 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10089
10090 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10091 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10092 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10093 inserted.
10094
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010095 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010096 - accept :
10097 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10098 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10099 the rules evaluation.
10100
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010101 - close :
10102 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10103 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10104 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10105 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10106 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10107 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010108 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010109 protocols.
10110
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010111 - reject :
10112 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10113 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010114 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010115
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010116 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10117 Sets a variable.
10118
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010119 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10120 Unsets a variable.
10121
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010122 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10123 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10124 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10125 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10126
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010127 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10128 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10129 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10130 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10131
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010132 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10133 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10134 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10135 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10136 continues.
10137
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010138 - "silent-drop" :
10139 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010140 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010141 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10142 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10143 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10144 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10145 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010146 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10147 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010148 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10149 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010150 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010151 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10152 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10153 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10154 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10155
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010156 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10157 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10158
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010159 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10160 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10161 for changing the default action to a reject.
10162
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010163 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10164 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10165 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10166 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010167 period.
10168
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010169 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10170 declared inline.
10171
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010172 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10173 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010174 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010175 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10176 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010177 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010178 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010179 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010180 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10181 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010182 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010183 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10184 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010185
10186 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10187 followed by some converters.
10188
10189 Example:
10190
10191 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10192
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010193 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10194 <var-name>.
10195
10196 Example:
10197
10198 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10199
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010200 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10201 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10202 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10203 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10204 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10205
10206 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10207
10208 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10209
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010210 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10211
10212 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10213
10214
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010215tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10216 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10218 no | yes | yes | no
10219 Arguments :
10220 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10221 below.
10222
10223 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10224
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010225 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010226 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10227 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10228 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10229 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10230 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10231 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10232 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010233 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010234 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10235 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10236 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10237 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10238 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10239 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10240 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10241 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10242 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10243 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10244 instead.
10245
10246 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10247 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10248 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10249 rules which may be inserted.
10250
10251 Several types of actions are supported :
10252 - accept : the request is accepted
10253 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10254 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10255 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010256 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010257 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10258 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010259 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010260 - silent-drop
10261
10262 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10263 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10264 sections for a complete description.
10265
10266 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10267 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10268 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10269
10270 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10271 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10272 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10273 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10274 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10275
10276 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10277 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10278
10279 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10280 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10281 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10282
10283 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10284 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10285 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10286
10287 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10288 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10289 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10290
10291 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10292 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10293 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10294
10295 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10296
10297 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10298
10299
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010300tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10301 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10303 no | no | yes | yes
10304 Arguments :
10305 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10306 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10307 as explained at the top of this document.
10308
10309 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10310
10311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010312timeout check <timeout>
10313 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10314 established.
10315
10316 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10317 yes | no | yes | yes
10318 Arguments:
10319 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10320 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10321 as explained at the top of this document.
10322
10323 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10324 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010325 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010326 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010327 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10328 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10329 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010330
10331 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10332 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10333
10334 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10335 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010336 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010337
10338 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10339 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10340 forget about it.
10341
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010342 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10343 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010344
10345
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010346timeout client <timeout>
10347timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10348 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10350 yes | yes | yes | no
10351 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010352 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010353 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10354 as explained at the top of this document.
10355
10356 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10357 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10358 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010359 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10360 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10361 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10362 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010363 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10364 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10365 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010366 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010367 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010368 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10369 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010370 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10371 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010372
10373 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10374 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10375 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10376 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10377 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10378 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10379
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010380 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010381
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010382 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10383 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10384 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10385
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010386 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10387 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010388
10389
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010390timeout client-fin <timeout>
10391 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10393 yes | yes | yes | no
10394 Arguments :
10395 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10396 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10397 as explained at the top of this document.
10398
10399 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10400 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10401 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10402 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10403 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10404 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10405 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010406 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10407 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10408 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010409
10410 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10411 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10412 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10413
10414 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10415
10416
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010417timeout connect <timeout>
10418timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10419 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10421 yes | no | yes | yes
10422 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010423 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010424 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10425 as explained at the top of this document.
10426
10427 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010428 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010429 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010430 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010431 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10432 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010433
10434 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10435 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10436 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10437 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10438 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10439 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10440
10441 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10442 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10443 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10444
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010445 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10446 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010447
10448
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010449timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10450 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10452 yes | yes | yes | yes
10453 Arguments :
10454 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10455 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10456 as explained at the top of this document.
10457
10458 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10459 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10460 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10461 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10462 once the request has started to present itself.
10463
10464 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10465 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10466 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10467 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10468 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10469
10470 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10471 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10472 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10473 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10474
10475 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10476 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010477 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010478 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10479 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010480 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010481
10482 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10483 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10484 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10485 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10486
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010487 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10488 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010489 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10490
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010491 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10492
10493
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010494timeout http-request <timeout>
10495 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010497 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010498 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010499 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010500 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10501 as explained at the top of this document.
10502
10503 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10504 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10505 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10506 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10507 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10508 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10509 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010510 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10511 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10512 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10513 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010514 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010515 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10516 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010517
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010518 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10519 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10520 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10521 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10522 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010523 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010524
10525 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10526 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010527 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010528 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10529 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10530
10531 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010532 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10533 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10534 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010535
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010536 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010537 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010538
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010539
10540timeout queue <timeout>
10541 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10543 yes | no | yes | yes
10544 Arguments :
10545 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10546 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10547 as explained at the top of this document.
10548
10549 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10550 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10551 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10552 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10553 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10554
10555 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10556 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10557 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10558 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10559
10560 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10561
10562
10563timeout server <timeout>
10564timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10565 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10567 yes | no | yes | yes
10568 Arguments :
10569 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10570 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10571 as explained at the top of this document.
10572
10573 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10574 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10575 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10576 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10577 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10578 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10579 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10580
10581 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10582 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10583 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10584 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10585 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010586 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010587 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010588 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10589 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010590 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10591 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010592
10593 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10594 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10595 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10596 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10597 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10598 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10599
10600 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10601 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10602 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10603
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010604 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010605
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010606
10607timeout server-fin <timeout>
10608 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10610 yes | no | yes | yes
10611 Arguments :
10612 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10613 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10614 as explained at the top of this document.
10615
10616 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10617 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10618 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10619 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10620 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10621 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10622 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10623 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10624 situations, it should not be needed.
10625
10626 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10627 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10628 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10629
10630 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10631
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010632
10633timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010634 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10636 yes | yes | yes | yes
10637 Arguments :
10638 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10639 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10640 as explained at the top of this document.
10641
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010642 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10643 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10644 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10645 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010646
10647 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10648 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10649 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10650 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010651 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010652
10653 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10654
10655
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010656timeout tunnel <timeout>
10657 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10659 yes | no | yes | yes
10660 Arguments :
10661 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10662 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10663 as explained at the top of this document.
10664
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010665 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010666 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10667 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10668 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010669 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10670 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010671 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10672 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10673 specified.
10674
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010675 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10676 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10677 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10678 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10679 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10680 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10681 state.
10682
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010683 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10684 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10685 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10686 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010687 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010688
10689 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10690 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10691 forget about it.
10692
10693 Example :
10694 defaults http
10695 option http-server-close
10696 timeout connect 5s
10697 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010698 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010699 timeout server 30s
10700 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10701
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010702 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010703
10704
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010705transparent (deprecated)
10706 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010708 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010709 Arguments : none
10710
10711 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10712 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10713 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10714 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10715 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10716 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10717 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10718 appropriate server.
10719
10720 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10721
10722 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10723 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10724
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010725 See also: "option transparent"
10726
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010727unique-id-format <string>
10728 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10730 yes | yes | yes | no
10731 Arguments :
10732 <string> is a log-format string.
10733
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010734 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10735 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10736 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10737 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010738
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010739 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10740 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10741 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10742 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10743 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10744 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10745 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10746 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010747
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010748 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10749 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010750
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010751 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010752
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010753 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010754
10755 will generate:
10756
10757 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10758
10759 See also: "unique-id-header"
10760
10761unique-id-header <name>
10762 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10764 yes | yes | yes | no
10765 Arguments :
10766 <name> is the name of the header.
10767
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010768 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10769 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010770
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010771 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010772
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010773 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010774 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10775
10776 will generate:
10777
10778 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10779
10780 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010781
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010782use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010783 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10785 no | yes | yes | no
10786 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010787 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10788 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010789
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010790 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10791 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010792
10793 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10794 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10795 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010796 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010797 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010798 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10799 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010800
10801 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10802 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10803 assign the backend.
10804
10805 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10806 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10807 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10808 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10809 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10810 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10811
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010812 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010813 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010814 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10815 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10816 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10817
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010818 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10819 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10820 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10821 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10822 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10823 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10824 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10825 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10826 cannot be forced from the request.
10827
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010828 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010829 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10830 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10831
10832 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10833 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010834
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010835
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010836use-server <server> if <condition>
10837use-server <server> unless <condition>
10838 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10840 no | no | yes | yes
10841 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010842 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010843
10844 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10845
10846 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10847 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10848 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10849
10850 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10851 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10852 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10853 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10854 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10855 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10856 matches will assign the server.
10857
10858 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10859 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10860 with the next rules until one matches.
10861
10862 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10863 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10864 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10865 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10866
10867 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10868 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10869 stripped.
10870
10871 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10872 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10873 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10874 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10875
10876 Example :
10877 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10878 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10879 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10880 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10881 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10882 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010883 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010884 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10885 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10886
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010887 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010888
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010889
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100108905. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010891--------------------------
10892
10893The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10894depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10895settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10896written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10897described in this section.
10898
10899
109005.1. Bind options
10901-----------------
10902
10903The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10904as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10905no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10906parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10907while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10908provided immediately after the setting name.
10909
10910The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10911
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010912accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10913 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10914 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10915 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10916 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10917 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10918 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10919 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10920 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10921 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010922 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10923 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10924 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010925
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010926accept-proxy
10927 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010928 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10929 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010930 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10931 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10932 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10933 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010934 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010935 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10936 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010937 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10938 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010939
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010940allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010941 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010942 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
10943 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
10944 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10945 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010946
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010947alpn <protocols>
10948 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10949 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10950 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10951 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10952 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010953 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10954 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10955 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10956 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10957 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10958 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10959 preference, like below :
10960
10961 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010962
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010963backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010964 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010965 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10966
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010967curves <curves>
10968 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10969 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10970 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10971 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10972 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10973 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10974
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010975ecdhe <named curve>
10976 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010977 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10978 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010979
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010980ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010981 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10982 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10983 client's certificate.
10984
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010985ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10986 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10987 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10988 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10989 error is ignored.
10990
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010991ca-sign-file <cafile>
10992 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10993 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10994 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10995 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10996 'generate-certificates' for details.
10997
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010998ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010999 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11000 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11001 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11002 'generate-certificates' for details.
11003
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011004ciphers <ciphers>
11005 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11006 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011007 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011008 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011009 information and recommendations see e.g.
11010 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11011 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11012 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11013
11014ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11015 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11016 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11017 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11018 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011019 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11020 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011021
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011022crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011023 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11024 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11025 to verify client's certificate.
11026
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011027crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11029 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11030 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11031 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11032 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11033 file.
11034
11035 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11036 are loaded.
11037
11038 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011039 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011040 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11041 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11042 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11043 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011044 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11045 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011046 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011047
11048 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11049 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11050 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11051 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011052 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11053 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011054
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011055 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011056
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011057 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011058 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011059 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11060 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011061 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11062 clients).
11063
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011064 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11065 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11066 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11067 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11068 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11069 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11070 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11071 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11072 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11073 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11074 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11075 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11076 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11077
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011078 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11079 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11080 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11081 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11082 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11083
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011084 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11085 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11086 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11087 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011088
11089 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11090 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11091 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11092 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11093 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11094 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11095 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11096 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11097 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11098
11099 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11100
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011101 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011102 a cert bundle.
11103
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011104 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011105 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11106 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11107 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11108 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11109 provide multi-cert support.
11110
11111 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11112
11113 Filename | CN | SAN
11114 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11115 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011116 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011117 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11118 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11119
11120 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11121 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11122 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11123 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011124 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11125 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11126 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011127
11128 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11129 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11130
11131 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11132 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11133 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11134
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011135crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011136 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011137 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011138 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011139 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011140
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011141crt-list <file>
11142 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011143 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11144 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011145
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011146 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11147
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011148 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11149 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011150 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011151 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011152
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011153 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11154 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11155 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11156 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11157 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11158 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11159 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11160 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011161
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011162 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011163 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011164 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11165 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11166 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011167
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011168 crt-list file example:
11169 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011170 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011171 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011172 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011173
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011174defer-accept
11175 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11176 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11177 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011178 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011179 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11180 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11181 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11182 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11183 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11184 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11185 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11186
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011187expose-fd listeners
11188 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11189 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011190 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11191 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011192 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011193
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011194force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011195 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011196 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011197 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011198 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011199
11200force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011201 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011202 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011203 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011204
11205force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011206 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011207 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011208 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011209
11210force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011211 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011212 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011213 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011214
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011215force-tlsv13
11216 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11217 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011218 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011219
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011220generate-certificates
11221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11222 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11223 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11224 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11225 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11226 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11227 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11228 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11229 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11230 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11231 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11232
11233 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11234 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011235 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011236 certificate is used many times.
11237
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011238gid <gid>
11239 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11240 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11241 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11242 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11243 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11244
11245group <group>
11246 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11247 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11248 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11249 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11250 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11251
11252id <id>
11253 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11254 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11255 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11256 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11257
11258interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011259 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11260 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11261 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11262 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11263 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11264 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011265 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11266 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11267 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11268 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11269 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11270 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011271
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011272level <level>
11273 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11274 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11275 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011276 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011277 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11278 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11279 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011280 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011281 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011282 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011283 all counters).
11284
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011285severity-output <format>
11286 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11287 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11288 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11289 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11290 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11291 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11292 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11293 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11294 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11295 rfc5424 convention.
11296
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011297maxconn <maxconn>
11298 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11299 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11300 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11301 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11302 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11303 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11304 eat all memory.
11305
11306mode <mode>
11307 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11308 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11309 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11310 UNIX sockets.
11311
11312mss <maxseg>
11313 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11314 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11315 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11316 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11317 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11318 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11319 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11320 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11321 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11322 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11323 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11324
11325name <name>
11326 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11327 page.
11328
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011329namespace <name>
11330 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11331 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11332 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11333 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11334
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011335nice <nice>
11336 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11337 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11338 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11339 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11340 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11341 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11342 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11343 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11344 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11345 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11346 one for an RDP socket.
11347
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011348no-ca-names
11349 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11350 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11351
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011352no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011353 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011354 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011355 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011356 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011357 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11358 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011359
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011360no-tls-tickets
11361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11362 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11363 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011364 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11365 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011366
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011367no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011368 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011369 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011370 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011371 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011372 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11373 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011374
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011375no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011376 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011377 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011378 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011379 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011380 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11381 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011382
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011383no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011384 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011385 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011386 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011387 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011388 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11389 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011390
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011391no-tlsv13
11392 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11393 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11394 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11395 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011396 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11397 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011398
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011399npn <protocols>
11400 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11401 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11402 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11403 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011404 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011405 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11406 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11407 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11408 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11409 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011410
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011411prefer-client-ciphers
11412 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11413 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11414 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011415 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11416 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11417 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011418
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011419process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011420 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011421 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011422 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011423 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11424 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11425 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11426 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011427 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011428 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11429 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11430 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11431 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11432 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011433
11434 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11435
11436 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11437 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11438 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11439 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11440 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11441 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11442 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11443 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011444
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011445proto <name>
11446 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11447 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11448 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11449 in haproxy -vv.
11450 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11451 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011452 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011453 h2" on the bind line.
11454
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011455ssl
11456 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011457 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011458 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11459 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011460 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11461 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011462
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011463ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11464 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11465 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11466 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11467
11468ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11469 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11470 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11471 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11472
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011473strict-sni
11474 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11475 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11476 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11477 See the "crt" option for more information.
11478
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011479tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011480 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011481 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11482 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011483 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011484 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11485 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11486 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11487 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11488 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11489 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11490 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11491
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011492tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011493 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011494 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11495 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11496 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11497 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11498 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11499 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11500 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011501 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11502 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11503 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011504
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011505tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11506 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011507 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11508 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11509 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11510 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11511 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11512 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11513 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11514 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11515 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11516 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011517 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11518 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11519
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011520transparent
11521 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11522 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11523 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11524 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11525 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11526 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11527 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11528 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11529 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11530 so check for support with your vendor.
11531
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011532v4v6
11533 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11534 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11535 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11536 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011537 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011538
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011539v6only
11540 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11541 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11542 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011543 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11544 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011545
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011546uid <uid>
11547 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11548 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11549 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11550 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11551 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11552
11553user <user>
11554 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11555 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11556 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11557 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11558 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11559
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011560verify [none|optional|required]
11561 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11562 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11563 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11564 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11565 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011566 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11567 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11568 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11569 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011570
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200115715.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011572------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011574The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11575which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11576arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11577settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11578after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11579Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11580address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011581
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011582 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011583 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011584
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011585Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11586keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11587
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011588The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011589
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011590addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011591 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011592 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11593 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11594 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11595 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11596 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011597
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011598agent-check
11599 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011600 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011601 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11602 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11603 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011604
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011605 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011606 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011607 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11608 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11609 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011610
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011611 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11612 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11613 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11614 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11615 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011616
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011617 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011618 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011619
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011620 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11621 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11622 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011623
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011624 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11625 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11626 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011627
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011628 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11629 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11630 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11631 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11632 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011633 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011634 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011635
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011636 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11637 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011638
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011639 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11640 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11641 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11642 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11643 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11644 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11645 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11646 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11647 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011648
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011649 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11650 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011651 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11652 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11653 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011654 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011655
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011656 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011657 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011658
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011659agent-send <string>
11660 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11661 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11662 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11663 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11664 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11665
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011666agent-inter <delay>
11667 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11668 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11669
11670 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11671 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11672 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11673 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11674 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11675 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11676 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11677 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11678 of backends use the same servers.
11679
11680 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11681
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011682agent-addr <addr>
11683 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11684
11685 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11686 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11687 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11688 hostname, it will be resolved.
11689
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011690agent-port <port>
11691 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11692
11693 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11694
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011695alpn <protocols>
11696 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11697 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11698 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11699 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11700 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11701 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11702 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11703 now obsolete NPN extension.
11704 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11705 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11706
11707 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011709backup
11710 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11711 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11712 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11713 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011714 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11715 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011716
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011717ca-file <cafile>
11718 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11719 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11720 server's certificate.
11721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011722check
11723 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011724 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11725 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11726 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11727 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11728 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11729 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11730 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011731 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11732 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011733 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11734 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011735
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011736check-send-proxy
11737 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11738 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11739 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11740 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11741 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11742 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11743 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11744
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011745check-alpn <protocols>
11746 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11747 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11748 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11749
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011750check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011751 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011752 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11753 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011754
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011755check-ssl
11756 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11757 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11758 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11759 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011760 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011761 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11762 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011763 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011764 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11765 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011766
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011767ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011768 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11769 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11770 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011771 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11772 information and recommendations see e.g.
11773 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11774 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11775 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011776
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011777ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11778 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11779 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11780 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11781 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011782 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11783 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11784 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011786cookie <value>
11787 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11788 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11789 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11790 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11791 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11792 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11793 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11794
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011795crl-file <crlfile>
11796 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11797 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11798 to verify server's certificate.
11799
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011800crt <cert>
11801 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11802 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11803 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11804 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11805 certificate request.
11806
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011807disabled
11808 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11809 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11810 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11811 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11812 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011813 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011814
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011815enabled
11816 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11817 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11818 default value.
11819 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11820 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011822error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011823 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11824 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11825 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011827 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011829fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011830 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11831 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11832 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11833
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011834force-sslv3
11835 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11836 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011837 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011838 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011839
11840force-tlsv10
11841 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011842 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011843 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011844
11845force-tlsv11
11846 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011847 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011848 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011849
11850force-tlsv12
11851 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011852 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011853 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011854
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011855force-tlsv13
11856 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11857 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011858 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011859
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011860id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011861 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11862 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11863 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011864
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011865init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11866 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11867 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011868 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011869 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11870 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11871 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11872 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11873 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11874 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11875 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11876 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11877 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011878 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011879 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11880 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11881 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11882 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11883 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11884 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011885 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011886
11887 Example:
11888 defaults
11889 # never fail on address resolution
11890 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11891
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011892inter <delay>
11893fastinter <delay>
11894downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011895 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11896 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11897 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11898 between checks depending on the server state :
11899
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011900 Server state | Interval used
11901 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11902 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11903 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11904 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11905 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11906 or yet unchecked. |
11907 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11908 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11909 | "inter" otherwise.
11910 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011912 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11913 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11914 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11915 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011916 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11917 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11918 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11919 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11920 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011921
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011922maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011923 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11924 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11925 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11926 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11927 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11928 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11929 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11930 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11931
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011932maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011933 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11934 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11935 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11936 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11937 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11938 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11939 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11940
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011941max-reuse <count>
11942 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11943 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11944 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11945 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11946 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11947 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11948 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11949 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11950
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011951minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011952 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11953 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11954 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11955 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11956 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11957 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011958 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011959 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011960
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011961namespace <name>
11962 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11963 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11964 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11965 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11966
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011967no-agent-check
11968 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11969 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11970 default value.
11971 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11972 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11973
11974no-backup
11975 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11976 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11977 default value.
11978 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11979 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11980
11981no-check
11982 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11983 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11984 default value.
11985 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11986 "default-server" "check" setting.
11987
11988no-check-ssl
11989 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11990 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11991 default value.
11992 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11993 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11994
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011995no-send-proxy
11996 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11997 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11998 default value.
11999 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12000 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12001
12002no-send-proxy-v2
12003 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12004 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12005 default value.
12006 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12007 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12008
12009no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12010 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12011 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12012 default value.
12013 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12014 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12015
12016no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12017 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12018 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12019 default value.
12020 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12021 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12022
12023no-ssl
12024 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12025 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12026 default value.
12027 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12028 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12029
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012030no-ssl-reuse
12031 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12032 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12033 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12034 and for paranoid users.
12035
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012036no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012037 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12038 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012039 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012040
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012041 Supported in default-server: No
12042
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012043no-tls-tickets
12044 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12045 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12046 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012047 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12048 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012049 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012050
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012051no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012052 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012053 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12054 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012055 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12056 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012057 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012058
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012059 Supported in default-server: No
12060
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012061no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012062 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012063 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12064 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012065 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12066 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012067 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012068
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012069 Supported in default-server: No
12070
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012071no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012072 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012073 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12074 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012075 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12076 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012077 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012078
12079 Supported in default-server: No
12080
12081no-tlsv13
12082 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12083 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12084 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12085 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12086 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012087 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012088
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012089 Supported in default-server: No
12090
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012091no-verifyhost
12092 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12093 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12094 default value.
12095 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12096 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012097
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012098non-stick
12099 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12100 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12101 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12102
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012103npn <protocols>
12104 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12105 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12106 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12107 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12108 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12109 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12110 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12111
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012112observe <mode>
12113 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12114 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12115 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12116 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12117 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12118 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012119 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012120
12121 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12122
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012123on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012124 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12125 Currently, four modes are available:
12126 - fastinter: force fastinter
12127 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12128 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12129 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12130 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12131
12132 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12133
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012134on-marked-down <action>
12135 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12136 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012137 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12138 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12139 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12140 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12141 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12142 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12143 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12144 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012145
12146 Actions are disabled by default
12147
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012148on-marked-up <action>
12149 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12150 Currently one action is available:
12151 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12152 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12153 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12154 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012155 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12156 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012157 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12158 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12159
12160 Actions are disabled by default
12161
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012162pool-max-conn <max>
12163 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12164 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12165 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12166 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12167 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12168 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12169
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012170pool-purge-delay <delay>
12171 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012172 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
12173 The default is 1s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012174
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012175port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012176 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12177 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12178 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12179 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12180 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12181 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12182
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012183proto <name>
12184
12185 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12186 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12187 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12188 reported in haproxy -vv.
12189 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12190 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12191
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012192redir <prefix>
12193 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12194 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12195 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12196 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12197 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12198 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12199 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12200 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012201 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012202 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012203 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12204 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12205 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12206 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12207
12208 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12209
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012210rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012211 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12212 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12213 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12214
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012215resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12216 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12217 server.
12218
12219 Available options:
12220
12221 * allow-dup-ip
12222 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12223 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12224 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12225 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12226 For such case, simply enable this option.
12227 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12228
12229 * prevent-dup-ip
12230 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12231 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12232 same fqdn.
12233 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12234
12235 Example:
12236 backend b_myapp
12237 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12238 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12239 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12240
12241 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12242 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12243 it
12244 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12245 different address
12246
12247 Default value: not set
12248
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012249resolve-prefer <family>
12250 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12251 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12252 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12253 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12254
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012255 Default value: ipv6
12256
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012257 Example:
12258
12259 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012260
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012261resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12262 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12263 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012264 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012265 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12266 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012267 configured network, another address is selected.
12268
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012269 Example:
12270
12271 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012272
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012273resolvers <id>
12274 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12275 hostname.
12276
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012277 Example:
12278
12279 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012280
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012281 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012282
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012283send-proxy
12284 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12285 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12286 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12287 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012288 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12289 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12290 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12291 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12292 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12293 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12294 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12295 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12296 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12297 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012298 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12299 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012300
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012301send-proxy-v2
12302 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12303 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12304 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12305 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012306 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12307 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12308 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12309 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012310
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012311proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12312 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12313 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012314 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12315 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012316 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12317 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012318 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012319
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012320send-proxy-v2-ssl
12321 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12322 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12323 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12324 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12325 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12326 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12327 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012328 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12329 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012330
12331send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12332 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12333 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12334 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12335 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12336 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12337 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12338 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12339 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012340 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12341 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012343slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012344 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12345 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12346 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12347 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12348 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12349 parameters :
12350
12351 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12352 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12353
12354 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12355 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12356 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12357 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12358
12359 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12360 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12361 seen as failed.
12362
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012363sni <expression>
12364 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12365 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12366 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12367 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012368 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12369 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012370 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012371 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12372 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012373
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012374source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012375source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012376source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012377 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12378 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12379 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12380 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12381
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012382 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12383 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12384 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12385 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12386 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12387 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12388 server.
12389
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012390 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12391 specifying the source address without port(s).
12392
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012393ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012394 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12395 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12396 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12397 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12398 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12399 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012400 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12401 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012402
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012403ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12404 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12405 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12406 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12407
12408ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12409 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12410 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12411 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12412
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012413ssl-reuse
12414 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12415 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12416 default value.
12417 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12418 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12419
12420stick
12421 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12422 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12423 default value.
12424 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12425 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012426
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012427tcp-ut <delay>
12428 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12429 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12430 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012431 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012432 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12433 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12434 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12435 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12436 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12437 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12438 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12439 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12440 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12441
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012442track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012443 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12444 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12445 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12446 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012447 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12448
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012449tls-tickets
12450 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12451 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12452 default value.
12453 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12454 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012455
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012456verify [none|required]
12457 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012458 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012459 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12460 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012461 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012462 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12463 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12464 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12465 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12466 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12467 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12468 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12469 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012470
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012471verifyhost <hostname>
12472 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012473 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12474 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12475 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12476 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12477 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12478 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12479 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12480 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012481
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012482weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012483 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12484 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12485 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012486 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12487 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12488 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12489 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12490 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12491 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012492
12493
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124945.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12495-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012496
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012497HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12498using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12499configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012500This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12501can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12502workload.
12503This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12504resolution at run time.
12505Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12506carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12507
12508
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200125095.3.1. Global overview
12510----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012511
12512As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12513different steps of the process life:
12514
12515 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12516 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12517 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12518
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012519 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12520 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012521
12522A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12523 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12524 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12525 resolution to know this new IP.
12526
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012527When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012528HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012529SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12530from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12531will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12532will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012533
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012534A few things important to notice:
12535 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12536 first valid response.
12537
12538 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12539 servers return an error.
12540
12541
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200125425.3.2. The resolvers section
12543----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012544
12545This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012546HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12547contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012548
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012549When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12550uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12551is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12552answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12553
12554When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012555used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012556
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012557 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12558 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12559 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012560
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012561 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12562 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012563
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012564 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12565 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12566 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012567
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012568For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12569following scenarios are possible:
12570
12571 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12572 ignored
12573
12574 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12575 applied
12576
12577 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12578 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12579
12580 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12581 retries the query with a new type
12582
12583 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12584 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012585
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012586As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12587a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012588<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012589
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012590
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012591resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012592 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012593
12594A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12595
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012596accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012597 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012598 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012599 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12600 by RFC 6891)
12601
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012602 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12603
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012604nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12605 DNS server description:
12606 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12607 <ip> : IP address of the server
12608 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12609
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012610parse-resolv-conf
12611 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12612 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12613 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12614
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012615hold <status> <period>
12616 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12617 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012618 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012619 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012620 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12621 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12622 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12623
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012624 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012625
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012626resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012627 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12628 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12629 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12630
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012631resolve_retries <nb>
12632 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12633 giving up.
12634 Default value: 3
12635
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012636 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12637 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12638 type.
12639
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012640timeout <event> <time>
12641 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12642 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12643 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012644 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12645 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012646 Default value: 1s
12647 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012648 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012649 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012650 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12651 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12652
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012653 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012654
12655 resolvers mydns
12656 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12657 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012658 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012659 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012660 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012661 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012662 hold other 30s
12663 hold refused 30s
12664 hold nx 30s
12665 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012666 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012667 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012668
12669
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126706. HTTP header manipulation
12671---------------------------
12672
12673In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12674response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12675request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12676which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012677against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012678
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012679If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12680to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12681but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12682HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12683stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12684because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12685a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12686still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012688This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12689in section 4.2 :
12690
12691 - reqadd <string>
12692 - reqallow <search>
12693 - reqiallow <search>
12694 - reqdel <search>
12695 - reqidel <search>
12696 - reqdeny <search>
12697 - reqideny <search>
12698 - reqpass <search>
12699 - reqipass <search>
12700 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12701 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12702 - reqtarpit <search>
12703 - reqitarpit <search>
12704 - rspadd <string>
12705 - rspdel <search>
12706 - rspidel <search>
12707 - rspdeny <search>
12708 - rspideny <search>
12709 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12710 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12711
12712With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12713is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12714parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12715prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12716Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12717
12718 \t for a tab
12719 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12720 \n for a new line (LF)
12721 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12722 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12723 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12724 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12725 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12726
12727The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12728portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12729above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12730regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
127319 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12732is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12733
12734The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12735after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12736
12737Notes related to these keywords :
12738---------------------------------
12739 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12740 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12741 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12742
12743 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12744 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12745 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12746
12747 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12748 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12749 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12750 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12751 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12752
12753 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12754 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12755 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12756 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12757 useless headers before adding new ones.
12758
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012759 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012760 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12761
12762 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12763 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12764 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12765
12766 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12767 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012768 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012769
12770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127717. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12772----------------------------------
12773
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012774HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012775client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12776The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12777these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12778but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12779data called patterns.
12780
12781
127827.1. ACL basics
12783---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012784
12785The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12786content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12787from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12788simple :
12789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012790 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012791 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012792 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12793 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012795The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12796adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012797
12798In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012800 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012801
12802This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12803Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12804and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012805an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12806conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12807as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12808are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012809
12810ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12811'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12812which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12813
12814There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12815performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012817The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12818specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12819this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012820methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12821ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012822
12823Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12824 - boolean
12825 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12826 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12827 - string
12828 - data block
12829
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012830Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12831converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12832would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12833The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12834which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12835
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012836Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12837keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12838fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12839which are summarized in the table below :
12840
12841 +---------------------+-----------------+
12842 | Sample or converter | Default |
12843 | output type | matching method |
12844 +---------------------+-----------------+
12845 | boolean | bool |
12846 +---------------------+-----------------+
12847 | integer | int |
12848 +---------------------+-----------------+
12849 | ip | ip |
12850 +---------------------+-----------------+
12851 | string | str |
12852 +---------------------+-----------------+
12853 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12854 +---------------------+-----------------+
12855
12856Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12857matching method, see below.
12858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012859The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12860 - boolean
12861 - integer or integer range
12862 - IP address / network
12863 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12864 - regular expression
12865 - hex block
12866
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012867The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12868
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012869 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12870 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012871 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012872 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012873 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012874 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012875 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012877The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12878read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12879if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12880lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12881will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12882beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12883a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12884lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12885exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12886
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012887The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12888parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12889ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12890a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12891check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12892
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012893The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12894socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12895file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012897Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12898loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12899
12900 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12901
12902In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12903the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12904case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12905as well.
12906
12907The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12908sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12909do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12910methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12911is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012912obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012913followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12914default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12915that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12916string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12917
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012918The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12919By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12920string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12921resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12922server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12923waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12924flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12925function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012927There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12928sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12929be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012930
12931 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12932 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012933 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12934 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12935 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12936 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012937
12938 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12939 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012940 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012941
12942 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012943 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012944
12945 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012946 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012947
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012948 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012949 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12950
12951 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12952 binary or string samples.
12953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012954 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12955 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012957 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12958 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12959 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012961 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12962 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012964 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12965 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012967 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12968 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012970 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12971 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012972 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012974 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12975 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12976 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012977
12978For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12979request, it is possible to do :
12980
12981 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12982
12983In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12984buffer, one would use the following acl :
12985
12986 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12987
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012988On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12989possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12990
12991 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012993All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12994criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12995method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12996to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12997criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12998the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013000If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013001the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13002For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013004 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13005 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13006 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13007 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013008
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013009
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013010The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13011types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13012combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13013brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13014default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013016 +-------------------------------------------------+
13017 | Input sample type |
13018 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013019 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013020 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13021 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13022 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013023 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013024 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013025 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013026 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013027 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013028 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013029 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013030 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013031 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013032 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013033 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013034 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013035 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013036 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013037 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013038 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013039 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013040 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013041 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013042 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013043 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013044 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13045 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13046 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013047
13048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130497.1.1. Matching booleans
13050------------------------
13051
13052In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13053Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13054When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13055that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13056
13057Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13058return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13059"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13060
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130627.1.2. Matching integers
13063------------------------
13064
13065Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13066enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13067to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13068
13069Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13070matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13071lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013072
13073For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13074unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13075representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13076
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013077As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13078two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13079instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13080ranges and operators.
13081
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013082For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013083operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13084Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13085of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013086
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013087Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013088
13089 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13090 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13091 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13092 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13093 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013095For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013096
13097 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13098
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013099This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13100
13101 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13102
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131047.1.3. Matching strings
13105-----------------------
13106
13107String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13108different forms :
13109
13110 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013111 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013112
13113 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013114 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013115
13116 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13117 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13118
13119 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13120 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13121
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013122 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013123 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13124 matches.
13125
13126 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13127 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13128 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013129
13130String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13131exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13132characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13133string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13134to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013135before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013136
13137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131387.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13139---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013140
13141Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13142they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13143possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13144passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13145the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013146the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13147match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013148
13149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131507.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13151-------------------------------------
13152
13153It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13154not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13155a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13156to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13157digits may be used upper or lower case.
13158
13159Example :
13160 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13161 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13162
13163
131647.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13165---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013166
13167IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13168netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13169within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013170host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013171difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13172at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13173does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13174parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013175
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013176The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13177abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13178
13179 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13180 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13181 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13182 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13183 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13184 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13185 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13186 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13187
13188Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13189192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13190
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013191IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13192Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13193trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13194IPv6 patterns.
13195
13196HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13197following situations :
13198 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13199 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13200 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13201 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13202 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13203 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13204 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13205 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13206 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13207 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013209
132107.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13211----------------------------------
13212
13213Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13214combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13215
13216 - AND (implicit)
13217 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13218 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013220A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013222 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013224Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13225indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013227For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13228"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13229requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13230is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13231
13232 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013233 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13234 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13235 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013236
13237To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13238and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13239
13240 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13241 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13242 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13243 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13244
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013245 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013246 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13247 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13248 use_backend www if host_www
13249
13250It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13251expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13252be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13253the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13254
13255 The following rule :
13256
13257 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013258 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013259
13260 Can also be written that way :
13261
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013262 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013263
13264It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13265to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13266simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13267sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13268good use is the following :
13269
13270 With named ACLs :
13271
13272 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13273 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13274 monitor fail if site_dead
13275
13276 With anonymous ACLs :
13277
13278 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13279
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013280See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13281keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013282
13283
132847.3. Fetching samples
13285---------------------
13286
13287Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13288against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13289sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13290ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13291of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13292available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13293
13294This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13295Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13296compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13297deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13298
13299The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13300matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13301method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13302indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13303
13304As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13305when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13306mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13307the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13308ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13309
13310Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13311multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13312when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013313incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13314are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013315is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13316all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13317
13318Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13319 - name
13320 - name(arg1)
13321 - name(arg1,arg2)
13322
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013323
133247.3.1. Converters
13325-----------------
13326
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013327Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13328of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13329is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13330was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013331has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013332unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13333
13334These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13335sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13336the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013337support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013338
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013339A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13340support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13341supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13342(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13343bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013345The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013346
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001334751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13348 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13349 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13350 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13351 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13352 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13353
13354 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013355 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13356 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013357 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13358 frontend http-in
13359 bind *:8081
13360 default_backend servers
13361 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13362 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13363
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013364add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013365 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013366 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013367 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13368 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013369 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013370 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13371 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13372 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13373 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013374 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013375 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013376
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013377aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13378 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13379 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13380 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13381 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13382 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13383 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13384
13385 Example:
13386 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13387 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13388
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013389and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013390 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013391 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013392 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13393 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013394 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013395 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13396 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13397 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13398 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013399 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013400 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013401
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013402b64dec
13403 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13404 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13405
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013406base64
13407 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013408 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013409 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13410
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013411bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013412 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013413 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013414 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013415 presence of a flag).
13416
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013417bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13418 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13419 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013420 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013421
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013422concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13423 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13424 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13425 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13426 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13427 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13428 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13429 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13430 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13431 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13432 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13433 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13434 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13435 delimitors.
13436
13437 Example:
13438 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13439 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13440 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13441 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13442
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013443cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013444 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13445 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013446
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013447crc32([<avalanche>])
13448 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13449 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13450 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13451 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13452 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13453 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13454 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13455 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13456 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13457 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013458 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13459
13460crc32c([<avalanche>])
13461 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13462 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13463 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13464 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13465 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13466 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13467 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13468 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013469
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013470da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013471 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13472 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13473 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13474 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013475 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013476 configuration language.
13477
13478 Example:
13479 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013480 bind *:8881
13481 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013482 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013483
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013484debug
13485 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13486 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13487 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13488
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013489div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013490 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13491 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013492 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013493 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13494 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013495 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013496 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13497 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13498 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13499 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013500 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013501 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013502
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013503djb2([<avalanche>])
13504 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13505 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13506 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13507 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13508 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13509 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13510 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013511 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13512 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013513
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013514even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013515 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013516 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13517
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013518field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13519 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13520 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13521 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13522 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13523 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13524 fields.
13525
13526 Example :
13527 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13528 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13529 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13530 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13531 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013532
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013533hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013534 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013535 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013536 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013537 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013538
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013539hex2i
13540 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13541 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13542
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013543http_date([<offset>])
13544 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13545 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13546 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13547 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13548 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13549 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013550
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013551in_table(<table>)
13552 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13553 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13554 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013555 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013556 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13557
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013558ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13559 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013560 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013561 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13562 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13563 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13564 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13565 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013566
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013567json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013568 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013569 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013570 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013571 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13572 of errors:
13573 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13574 bytes, ...)
13575 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13576 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13577
13578 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13579 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13580 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13581 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13582 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13583 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013584 - "ascii" : never fails;
13585 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13586 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013587 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013588 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013589 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13590 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13591
13592 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013593 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013594
13595 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013596 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013597 capture request header user-agent len 150
13598 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013599
13600 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13601 GET / HTTP/1.0
13602 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13603
13604 Output log:
13605 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13606
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013607language(<value>[,<default>])
13608 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13609 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13610 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13611 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13612 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13613 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13614 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13615 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13616 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013617 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013618 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13619 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013620
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013621 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013622
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013623 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13624 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013625
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013626 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13627 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13628 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13629 use_backend spanish if es
13630 use_backend french if fr
13631 use_backend english if en
13632 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013633
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013634length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013635 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13636 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13637 type. The result is of type integer.
13638
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013639lower
13640 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13641 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13642 type. The result is of type string.
13643
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013644ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13645 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13646 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13647 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13648 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13649 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13650 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13651
13652 Example :
13653
13654 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013655 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013656 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13657
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013658map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13659map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13660map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13661 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13662 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13663 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13664 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13665 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13666 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13667 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13668 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013669
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013670 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13671 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13672 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013673
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013674 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013675 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013676
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013677 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13678 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13679 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13680 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013681 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13682 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013683 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13684 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13685 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13686 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13687 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13688 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13689 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13690 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013691 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13692 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13693 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013694 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13695 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13696 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13697 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13698 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013699
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013700 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13701 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13702 the corresponding match text.
13703
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013704 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13705 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13706 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13707 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13708 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013709
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013710 Example :
13711
13712 # this is a comment and is ignored
13713 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13714 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13715 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13716 | | | `---------- value
13717 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13718 | `---------------------------- key
13719 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13720
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013721mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013722 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13723 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013724 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013725 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013726 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013727 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13728 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13729 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13730 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013731 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013732 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013733
13734mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013735 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013736 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13737 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013738 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013739 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013740 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013741 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13742 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13743 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13744 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013745 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013746 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013747
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013748nbsrv
13749 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13750 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13751 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13752 map lookup.
13753
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013754neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013755 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13756 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13757 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13758 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013759
13760not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013761 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013762 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013763 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013764 absence of a flag).
13765
13766odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013767 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013768 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13769
13770or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013771 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013772 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013773 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13774 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013775 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013776 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13777 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13778 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13779 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013780 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013781 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013782
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013783protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13784 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13785 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13786 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13787 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13788 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13789 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13790 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13791 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13792 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13793 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13794 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13795
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013796regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013797 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13798 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13799 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13800 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13801 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13802 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13803 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13804 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13805 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13806 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013807 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13808 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13809 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13810 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013811
13812 Example :
13813
13814 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13815 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13816 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13817 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13818
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013819capture-req(<id>)
13820 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13821 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13822
13823 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013824 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13825 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013826
13827capture-res(<id>)
13828 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13829 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13830
13831 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013832 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13833 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013834
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013835sdbm([<avalanche>])
13836 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13837 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13838 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13839 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13840 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13841 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13842 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013843 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13844 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013845
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013846set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013847 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13848 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13849 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013850 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013851 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13852 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013853 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013854 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13855 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013856 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013857 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013858
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013859sha1
13860 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13861 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13862
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013863strcmp(<var>)
13864 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13865 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13866 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13867 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13868 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13869 shorter).
13870
13871 Example :
13872
13873 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13874 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13875 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13876
13877
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013878sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013879 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13880 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013881 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013882 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13883 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013884 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013885 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13886 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013887 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013888 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13889 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013890 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013891 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013892
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013893table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13894 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13895 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13896 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13897 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13898 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13899 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13900
13901
13902table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13903 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13904 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13905 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13906 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13907 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13908 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13909
13910table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13911 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13912 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013913 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013914 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13915 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13916
13917table_conn_cur(<table>)
13918 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13919 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13920 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13921 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13922 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13923
13924table_conn_rate(<table>)
13925 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13926 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13927 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13928 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13929 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13930
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013931table_gpt0(<table>)
13932 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13933 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13934 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13935 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13936 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13937
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013938table_gpc0(<table>)
13939 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13940 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13941 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13942 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13943 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13944
13945table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13946 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13947 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13948 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13949 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13950 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13951 sample fetch keyword.
13952
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013953table_gpc1(<table>)
13954 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13955 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13956 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13957 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13958 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13959
13960table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13961 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13962 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13963 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13964 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13965 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13966 sample fetch keyword.
13967
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013968table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13969 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13970 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013971 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013972 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13973 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13974
13975table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13976 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13977 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13978 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13979 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13980 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13981 keyword.
13982
13983table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13984 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13985 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013986 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013987 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13988 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13989
13990table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13991 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13992 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13993 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13994 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13995 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13996 keyword.
13997
13998table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13999 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14000 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014001 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014002 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14003 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14004 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14005 keyword.
14006
14007table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14008 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14009 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014010 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014011 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14012 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14013 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14014 keyword.
14015
14016table_server_id(<table>)
14017 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14018 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14019 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14020 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14021 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14022 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14023
14024table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14025 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14026 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014027 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014028 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14029 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14030 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14031 keyword.
14032
14033table_sess_rate(<table>)
14034 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14035 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14036 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14037 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14038 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14039 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14040 keyword.
14041
14042table_trackers(<table>)
14043 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14044 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14045 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14046 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14047 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14048 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14049 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14050 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14051 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14052 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14053
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014054upper
14055 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14056 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14057 type. The result is of type string.
14058
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014059url_dec
14060 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14061 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14062
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014063ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014064 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014065 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14066 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14067 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014068 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14069 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14070 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14071 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014072 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014073 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14074 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014075
14076 Example:
14077 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14078 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14079
14080 message Point {
14081 int32 latitude = 1;
14082 int32 longitude = 2;
14083 }
14084
14085 message PPoint {
14086 Point point = 59;
14087 }
14088
14089 message Rectangle {
14090 // One corner of the rectangle.
14091 PPoint lo = 48;
14092 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14093 PPoint hi = 49;
14094 }
14095
14096 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14097 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14098 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14099
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014100 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14101 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14102 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
14103 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14104
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014105 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014106
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014107 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014108
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014109 As a gRPC message is alway made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
14110 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14111 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14112
14113 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14114 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14115 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14116
14117 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14118 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14119 interpret the previous binary sample.
14120
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014121
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014122unset-var(<var name>)
14123 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14124 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14125 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14126 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14127 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14128 response),
14129 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14130 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14131 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14132 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14133
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014134utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14135 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14136 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14137 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14138 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14139 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14140 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14141
14142 Example :
14143
14144 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014145 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014146 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14147
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014148word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14149 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14150 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14151 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14152 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14153 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14154
14155 Example :
14156 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14157 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14158 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14159 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14160 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014161
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014162wt6([<avalanche>])
14163 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14164 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14165 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14166 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14167 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14168 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14169 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014170 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14171 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014172
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014173xor(<value>)
14174 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014175 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014176 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014177 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014178 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014179 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14180 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014181 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014182 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14183 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014184 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014185 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014186
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014187xxh32([<seed>])
14188 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14189 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14190 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14191 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14192 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14193 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14194 as cryptographically secure.
14195
14196xxh64([<seed>])
14197 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14198 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14199 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14200 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14201 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14202 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14203 as cryptographically secure.
14204
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014205
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200142067.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014207--------------------------------------------
14208
14209A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14210not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14211"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14212The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14213
14214always_false : boolean
14215 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14216 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14217
14218always_true : boolean
14219 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14220 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14221
14222avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014223 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014224 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14225 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14226 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14227 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14228 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14229 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14230 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14231 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14232 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14233 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14234 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14235 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14236 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014238be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014239 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14240 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14241 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14242 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014243 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14244
14245be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14246 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14247 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14248 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14249 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14250 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014251 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14252 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014253
14254 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14255 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14256 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014258be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14259 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14260 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14261 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014262 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014263 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14264 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014265
14266 Example :
14267 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14268 backend dynamic
14269 mode http
14270 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14271 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014272
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014273bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014274 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14275 of the string.
14276
14277bool(<bool>) : bool
14278 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14279 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014281connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14282 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014283 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014284 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14285 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014286
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014287 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014288 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014289 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14290
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014291 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14292 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014293
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014294 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014295 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014296 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014297 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014298 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014299 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014300 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014301
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014302 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14303 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014304 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014305 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014306
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014307cpu_calls : integer
14308 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14309 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14310 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14311 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14312 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14313 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14314
14315cpu_ns_avg : integer
14316 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14317 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14318 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14319 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14320 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14321 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14322 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14323 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14324 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14325 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14326 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14327
14328cpu_ns_tot : integer
14329 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14330 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14331 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14332 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14333 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14334 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14335 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14336 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14337 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14338 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14339 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14340 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14341 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14342
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014343date([<offset>]) : integer
14344 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14345 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14346 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14347 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014348 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14349
14350 Example :
14351
14352 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14353 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014354
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014355date_us : integer
14356 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14357 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14358 from the same timeval structure.
14359
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014360distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14361 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14362 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14363 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14364 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14365 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14366 list of supported tokens.
14367
14368distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14369 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14370 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14371 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14372 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14373 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14374 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14375 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14376 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14377 supported tokens.
14378
14379 Example :
14380 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14381 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14382 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14383 # send large files to the big farm
14384 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14385
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014386env(<name>) : string
14387 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14388 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14389 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14390 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14391 certain way.
14392
14393 Examples :
14394 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14395 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14396
14397 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14398 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014400fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14401 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014402 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14403 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014404 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14405 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014406 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014407 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14408 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014409
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014410fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14411 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14412 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14413 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014415fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14416 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14417 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14418 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14419 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14420 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14421 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14422 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14423 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014424
14425 Example :
14426 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14427 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14428 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14429 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14430 frontend mail
14431 bind :25
14432 mode tcp
14433 maxconn 100
14434 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14435 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14436 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14437 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014438
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014439hostname : string
14440 Returns the system hostname.
14441
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014442int(<integer>) : signed integer
14443 Returns a signed integer.
14444
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014445ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14446 Returns an ipv4.
14447
14448ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14449 Returns an ipv6.
14450
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014451lat_ns_avg : integer
14452 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14453 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14454 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14455 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14456 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14457 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14458 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14459 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14460 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14461 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14462 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14463 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14464 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14465 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14466
14467lat_ns_tot : integer
14468 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14469 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14470 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14471 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14472 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14473 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14474 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14475 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14476 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14477 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14478 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14479 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14480 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14481 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14482 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14483 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14484 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14485 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14486 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14487
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014488meth(<method>) : method
14489 Returns a method.
14490
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014491nbproc : integer
14492 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14493 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14494 and debugging purposes.
14495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014496nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14497 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14498 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14499 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014500 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14501 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14502 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014503
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014504prio_class : integer
14505 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14506 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14507 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14508
14509prio_offset : integer
14510 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14511 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14512 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14513 set-priority-offset".
14514
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014515proc : integer
14516 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14517 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14518 debugging purposes.
14519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014520queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014521 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14522 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14523 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014524 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14525 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14526 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14527 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14528 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14529
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014530rand([<range>]) : integer
14531 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14532 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14533 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14534 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14535 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014537srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14538 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14539 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14540 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14541 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14542 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014543 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14544 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14545
14546srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14547 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14548 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14549 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14550 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14551 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14552 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14553 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14554
14555 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14556 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014557
14558srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14559 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14560 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14561 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014562 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014563 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14564 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14565 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14566
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014567srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14568 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14569 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14570 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14571 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14572 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14573 fetch methods.
14574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014575srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14576 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14577 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014578 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014579 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14580 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014581 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014582 overloading servers).
14583
14584 Example :
14585 # Redirect to a separate back
14586 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14587 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14588 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14589
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014590stopping : boolean
14591 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14592 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14593 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14594
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014595str(<string>) : string
14596 Returns a string.
14597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014598table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14599 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14600 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14601
14602table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14603 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14604 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14605 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14606
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014607thread : integer
14608 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14609 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14610 and debugging purposes.
14611
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014612var(<var-name>) : undefined
14613 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014614 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14615 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014616 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014617 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14618 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014619 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014620 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14621 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014622 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014623 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014624
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146257.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014626----------------------------------
14627
14628The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14629closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14630methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14631sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14632TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014633the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14634counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014635"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14636used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14637can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14638Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14639table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14640tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14641currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014642
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014643bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014644 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14645 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14646 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014648be_id : integer
14649 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14650 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14651
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014652be_name : string
14653 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14654 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014656dst : ip
14657 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14658 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14659 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14660 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014661 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14662 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14663 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14664 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14665 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14666 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014667
14668dst_conn : integer
14669 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14670 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14671 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14672 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14673 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14674 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14675 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14676 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014677
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014678dst_is_local : boolean
14679 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14680 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14681 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14682 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014683 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014684 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14685 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14686 it only once per connection.
14687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014688dst_port : integer
14689 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14690 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14691 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14692 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14693 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14694 an HTTP header.
14695
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014696fc_http_major : integer
14697 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14698 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14699 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14700
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014701fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14702 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14703 header.
14704
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014705fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14706 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14707 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14708 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14709 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14710 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14711 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14712
14713fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14714 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14715 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14716 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14717 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14718 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14719 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14720
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014721fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14722 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14723 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14724 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14725 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14726
14727fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14728 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14729 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14730 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14731 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14732
14733fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14734 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14735 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14736 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14737 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14738
14739fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14740 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14741 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14742 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14743 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14744
14745fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14746 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14747 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14748 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14749 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14750
14751fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14752 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14753 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14754 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14755 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14756
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014757fe_defbe : string
14758 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14759 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014761fe_id : integer
14762 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014763 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014764 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14765
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014766fe_name : string
14767 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14768 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14769 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14770
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014771sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014772sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14773sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14774sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014775 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14776 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14777 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14778
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014779sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014780sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14781sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14782sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014783 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14784 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14785 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14786
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014787sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014788sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14789sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14790sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014791 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14792 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014793 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14794 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14795 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014796
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014797 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014798 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14799 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014800 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14801 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14802 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014803 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14804 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14805
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014806sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14807sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14808sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14809sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14810 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14811 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14812 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14813 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14814 when a first ACL was verified.
14815
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014816sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014817sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14818sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14819sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014820 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014821 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14822
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014823sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014824sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14825sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14826sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014827 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14828 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14829 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14830
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014831sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014832sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14833sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14834sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014835 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14836 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14837 See also src_conn_rate.
14838
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014839sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014840sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14841sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14842sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014843 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014844 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014845
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014846sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14847sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14848sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14849sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14850 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14851 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14852
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014853sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14854sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14855sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14856sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14857 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14858 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14859
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014860sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014861sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14862sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14863sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014864 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14865 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14866 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014867 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14868 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14869 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014870
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014871sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14872sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14873sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14874sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14875 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14876 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14877 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14878 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14879 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14880 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14881
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014882sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014883sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14884sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14885sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014886 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014887 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14888 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14889
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014890sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014891sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14892sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14893sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014894 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14895 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14896 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14897 src_http_err_rate.
14898
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014899sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014900sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14901sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14902sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014903 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014904 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14905 src_http_req_cnt.
14906
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014907sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014908sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14909sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14910sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014911 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14912 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14913 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14914 src_http_req_rate.
14915
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014916sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014917sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14918sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14919sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014920 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014921 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14922 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14923 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14924 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014925
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014926 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014927 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14928 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014929 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14930
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014931sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14932sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14933sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14934sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14935 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14936 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14937 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14938 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14939 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14940
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014941sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014942sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14943sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14944sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014945 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14946 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14947 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014948
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014949sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014950sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14951sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14952sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014953 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14954 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14955 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014956
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014957sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014958sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14959sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14960sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014961 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014962 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14963 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14964 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014965 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014966 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14967
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014968sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014969sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14970sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14971sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014972 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14973 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14974 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14975 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14976 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014977 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014978
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014979sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014980sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14981sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14982sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014983 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14984 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14985 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14986
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014987sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014988sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14989sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14990sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014991 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14992 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014993 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014994 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14995 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014996 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14997 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14998 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015000so_id : integer
15001 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15002 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15003 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015005src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015006 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015007 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15008 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15009 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015010 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15011 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15012 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015013 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15014 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15015 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15016 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15017 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15018 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15019 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015020
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015021 Example:
15022 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15023 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015025src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15026 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15027 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15028 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015029 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015031src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15032 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15033 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015034 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015035 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015037src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15038 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15039 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15040 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15041 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15042 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15043 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015044
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015045 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015046 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15047 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15048 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15049 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015050 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015051 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15052 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15053
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015054src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15055 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15056 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15057 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15058 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15059 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15060 was verified.
15061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015062src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015063 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015064 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015065 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015066 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015068src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015069 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015070 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15071 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015072 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015074src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15075 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15076 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15077 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015078 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015080src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015081 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015082 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015083 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015084 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015085
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015086src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15087 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15088 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15089 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15090 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15091
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015092src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15093 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15094 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15095 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15096 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015098src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015099 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015100 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015101 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15102 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015103 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15104 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15105 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015106
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015107src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15108 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15109 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15110 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15111 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15112 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15113 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15114 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015116src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015117 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015118 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015119 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015120 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015121 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015123src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15124 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15125 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15126 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15127 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015128 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015130src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015131 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015132 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15133 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015134 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015136src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15137 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15138 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15139 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015140 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015141 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015143src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15144 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15145 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15146 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015147 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015148 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15149 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015150
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015151 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015152 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015153 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015154 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015155
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015156src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15157 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15158 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15159 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15160 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15161 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15162 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15163
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015164src_is_local : boolean
15165 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15166 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15167 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15168 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015169 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015170 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15171 once per connection.
15172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015173src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015174 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15175 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15176 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15177 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15178 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015180src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015181 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15182 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15183 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15184 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15185 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015187src_port : integer
15188 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15189 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15190 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15191 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015193src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015194 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015195 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15196 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15197 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015198 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015200src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15201 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15202 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15203 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15204 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015205 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015207src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15208 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15209 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15210 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15211 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15212 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15213 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15214 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15215 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015216
15217 Example :
15218 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15219 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15220 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15221 listen ssh
15222 bind :22
15223 mode tcp
15224 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015225 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015226 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015227 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015229srv_id : integer
15230 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15231 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15232 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015233
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200152347.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015235----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015237The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15238closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15239when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15240usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015241future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015242
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001524351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15244 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15245 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15246 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15247 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15248 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15249
15250 Example :
15251 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15252 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15253 # the request.
15254 frontend http-in
15255 bind *:8081
15256 default_backend servers
15257 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15258 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15259
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015260ssl_bc : boolean
15261 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15262 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15263 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15264
15265ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15266 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15267 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15268
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015269ssl_bc_alpn : string
15270 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15271 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15272 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15273 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15274 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15275 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15276 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15277 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15278 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15279
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015280ssl_bc_cipher : string
15281 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15282 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15283
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015284ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15285 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15286 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15287 session or a TLS ticket.
15288
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015289ssl_bc_npn : string
15290 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15291 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15292 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15293 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15294 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15295 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15296 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15297 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15298
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015299ssl_bc_protocol : string
15300 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15301 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15302
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015303ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015304 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015305 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15306 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015307
15308ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15309 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15310 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15311 if session was reused or not.
15312
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015313ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15314 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15315 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15316 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15317 BoringSSL.
15318
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015319ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15320 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15321 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015323ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15324 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15325 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15326 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15327 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15328 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015330ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15331 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15332 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15333 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15334 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015335
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015336ssl_c_der : binary
15337 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15338 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15339 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015341ssl_c_err : integer
15342 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15343 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15344 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15345 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15346 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015348ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15349 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15350 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15351 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15352 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15353 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15354 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15355 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15356 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015358ssl_c_key_alg : string
15359 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15360 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15361 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015363ssl_c_notafter : string
15364 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15365 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15366 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015368ssl_c_notbefore : string
15369 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15370 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15371 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015373ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15374 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15375 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15376 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15377 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15378 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15379 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15380 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15381 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015383ssl_c_serial : binary
15384 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15385 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15386 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015388ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15389 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15390 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15391 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015392 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15393 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15394
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015395 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015396 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015398ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15399 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15400 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15401 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015403ssl_c_used : boolean
15404 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15405 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015407ssl_c_verify : integer
15408 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15409 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15410 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15411 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015413ssl_c_version : integer
15414 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15415 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015416
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015417ssl_f_der : binary
15418 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15419 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15420 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015422ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15423 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15424 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15425 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15426 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015427 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015428 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15429 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15430 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015432ssl_f_key_alg : string
15433 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15434 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15435 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015437ssl_f_notafter : string
15438 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15439 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15440 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015442ssl_f_notbefore : string
15443 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15444 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15445 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015447ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15448 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15449 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15450 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15451 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15452 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15453 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15454 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15455 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015457ssl_f_serial : binary
15458 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15459 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15460 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015461
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015462ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15463 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15464 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15465 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015467ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15468 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15469 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15470 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015472ssl_f_version : integer
15473 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15474 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15475
15476ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015477 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15478 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15479 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015481 Example :
15482 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15483 listen http-https
15484 bind :80
15485 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15486 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15487
15488ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15489 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15490 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15491
15492ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015493 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015494 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15495 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15496 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15497 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15498 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15499 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15500 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15501 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015503ssl_fc_cipher : string
15504 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15505 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015506
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015507ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15508 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15509 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015510 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015511
15512ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15513 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15514 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015515 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015516
15517ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15518 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15519 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15520 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015521 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015522 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015523
15524ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15525 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15526 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015527 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015529ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015530 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15531 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015532 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15533 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15534 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15535 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015536
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015537ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15538 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15539 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15540 wait until the handshake happened.
15541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015542ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15543 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015544 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15545 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15546 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15547 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015548
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015549ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015550 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015551 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15552 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015554ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015555 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015556 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15557 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15558 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15559 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15560 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15561 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15562 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015564ssl_fc_protocol : string
15565 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15566 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015567
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015568ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015569 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015570 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15571 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015573ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15574 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15575 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15576 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15577 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015578
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015579ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15580 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15581 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15582 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15583 BoringSSL.
15584
15585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015586ssl_fc_sni : string
15587 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15588 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15589 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15590 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15591 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15592
15593 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15594 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15595 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015596 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15597 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015599 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015600 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15601 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015603ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15604 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15605 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015606
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015607
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156087.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015609------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015611Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15612sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15613only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15614For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15615be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15616can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15617sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15618for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15619content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015621payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015622 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15624 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015626payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15627 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015628 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015629 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015630
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015631req.hdrs : string
15632 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15633 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15634 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15635 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15636
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015637req.hdrs_bin : binary
15638 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15639 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15640 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15641 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15642 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15643 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15644
15645 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15646
15647 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15648 str: <int:length><bytes>
15649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650req.len : integer
15651req_len : integer (deprecated)
15652 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15653 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15654 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15655 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15656 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15657 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15658 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15659 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015661req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15662 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015663 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15664 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15665 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15666 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015668 ACL alternatives :
15669 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015671req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15672 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15673 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15674 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15675 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015677 ACL alternatives :
15678 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015682req.proto_http : boolean
15683req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15684 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15685 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15686 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15687 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15688 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15689 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15690 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015692 Example:
15693 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15694 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15695 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015696 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015698req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15699rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15700 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15701 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15702 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15703 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15704 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15705 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15706 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015708 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15709 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15710 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15711 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15712 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15713 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715 ACL derivatives :
15716 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718 Example :
15719 listen tse-farm
15720 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15721 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15722 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15723 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15724 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15725 persist rdp-cookie
15726 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15727 # This is only useful makes sense if
15728 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15729 stick-table type string size 204800
15730 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15731 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15732 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015734 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15735 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015737req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15738rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15739 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15740 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15741 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15742 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015744 ACL derivatives :
15745 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015746
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015747req.ssl_alpn : string
15748 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15749 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15750 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15751 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15752 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15753 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015754 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015755
15756 Examples :
15757 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15758 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15759 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015760 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015761 default_backend bk_default
15762
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015763req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15764 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15765 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015766 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15767 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15768 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15769 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15770 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015772req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15773req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15774 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15775 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15776 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15777 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15778 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15779 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15780 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015782req.ssl_sni : string
15783req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15784 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15785 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15786 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15787 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15788 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15789 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15790 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15791 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15792 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15793 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15794 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15795 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015797 ACL derivatives :
15798 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015800 Examples :
15801 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15802 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15803 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15804 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15805 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015806
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015807req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15808 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15809 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15810 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15811 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15812 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15813 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15814 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15815 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15816 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015818req.ssl_ver : integer
15819req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15820 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15821 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15822 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15823 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15824 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15825 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15826 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015827 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015828 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015830 ACL derivatives :
15831 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015832
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015833res.len : integer
15834 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15835 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15836 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15837 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15838 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15839 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15840 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15841 content inspection.
15842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015843res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15844 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015845 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15846 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15847 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15848 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015850res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15851 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15852 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15853 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15854 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015856 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015857
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015858res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15859rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15860 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15861 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15862 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15863 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15864 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15865 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15866 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015868wait_end : boolean
15869 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15870 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015871 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015872 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15873 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015874 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015875 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15876 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015878 Examples :
15879 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15880 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15881 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015883 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15884 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15885 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15886 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15887 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15888 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15889 tcp-request content reject
15890
15891
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015893--------------------------------------
15894
15895It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15896This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15897data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15898its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15899HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15900content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15901to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15902more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15903response are indexed.
15904
15905base : string
15906 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15907 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15908 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15909 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15910 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15911 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15912 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15913 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15914
15915 ACL derivatives :
15916 base : exact string match
15917 base_beg : prefix match
15918 base_dir : subdir match
15919 base_dom : domain match
15920 base_end : suffix match
15921 base_len : length match
15922 base_reg : regex match
15923 base_sub : substring match
15924
15925base32 : integer
15926 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15927 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15928 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015929 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15930 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15931 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015932
15933base32+src : binary
15934 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15935 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15936 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15937 per-URL counters.
15938
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015939capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15940 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15941 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15942 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15943
15944capture.req.method : string
15945 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15946 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15947 because it's allocated.
15948
15949capture.req.uri : string
15950 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15951 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15952 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15953 allocated.
15954
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015955capture.req.ver : string
15956 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15957 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15958 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15959
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015960capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15961 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15962 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15963 The first entry is an index of 0.
15964 See also: "capture response header"
15965
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015966capture.res.ver : string
15967 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15968 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15969 persistent flag.
15970
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015971req.body : binary
15972 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15973 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15974 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15975 the first chunk is analyzed.
15976
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015977req.body_param([<name>) : string
15978 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15979 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15980 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15981 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15982 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15983 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15984 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15985 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15986 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15987 given.
15988
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015989req.body_len : integer
15990 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15991 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15992 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15993 "option http-buffer-request".
15994
15995req.body_size : integer
15996 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15997 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15998 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15999 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16000 "option http-buffer-request".
16001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016002req.cook([<name>]) : string
16003cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16004 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16005 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16006 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16007 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16008 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16009 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16010 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16011 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16012
16013 ACL derivatives :
16014 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16015 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16016 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16017 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16018 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16019 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16020 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16021 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016023req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16024cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16025 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16026 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016028req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16029cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16030 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16031 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16032 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16033 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016035cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16036 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16037 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16038 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16039 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016040 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16042 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16043 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16044 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016046hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16047 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16048 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16049 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16050 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016051 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016053req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16054 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16055 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16056 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16057 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16058 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16059 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16060 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16061 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016063req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16064 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16065 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16066 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16067 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016069req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16070 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16071 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16072 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16073 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16074 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16075 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16076 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16077 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016078 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016079 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016080 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016082 ACL derivatives :
16083 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16084 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16085 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16086 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16087 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16088 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16089 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16090 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16091
16092req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16093hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16094 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16095 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16096 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16097 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16098 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16099 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16100 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16101 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16102 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16103
16104req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16105hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16106 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16107 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16108 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16109 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16110 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016111 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016112 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16113 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16114
16115req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16116hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16117 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16118 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16119 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16120 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16121 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16122 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16123 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16124
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016125
16126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016127http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16128 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16129 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16130 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16131 basic auth is supported.
16132
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016133http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16134 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16135 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16136 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16137 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016138 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16139 basic auth is supported.
16140
16141 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016142 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16143 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16144 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16145 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016146
16147http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016148 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16149 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016150 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16151 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016153method : integer + string
16154 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16155 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16156 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16157 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16158 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16159 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16160 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016162 ACL derivatives :
16163 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016165 Example :
16166 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16167 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16168 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016170path : string
16171 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16172 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16173 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16174 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16175 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016176 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016177 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016179 ACL derivatives :
16180 path : exact string match
16181 path_beg : prefix match
16182 path_dir : subdir match
16183 path_dom : domain match
16184 path_end : suffix match
16185 path_len : length match
16186 path_reg : regex match
16187 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016188
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016189query : string
16190 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16191 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16192 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16193 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016194 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016195 which stops before the question mark.
16196
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016197req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16198 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16199 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16200 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16201 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016203req.ver : string
16204req_ver : string (deprecated)
16205 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16206 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16207 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016209 ACL derivatives :
16210 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016212res.comp : boolean
16213 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16214 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16215 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016217res.comp_algo : string
16218 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16219 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16220 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016222res.cook([<name>]) : string
16223scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16224 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16225 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16226 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016228 ACL derivatives :
16229 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16232scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16233 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16234 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16235 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016237res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16238scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16239 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16240 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16241 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016243res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16244 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16245 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16246 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16247 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16248 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16249 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16250 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16251 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16252 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016254res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16255 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16256 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16257 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16258 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16259 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016261res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16262shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16263 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16264 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16265 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16266 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16267 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16268 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16269 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16270 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016272 ACL derivatives :
16273 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16274 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16275 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16276 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16277 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16278 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16279 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16280 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16281
16282res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16283shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16284 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16285 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16286 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16287 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16288 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016290res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16291shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16292 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16293 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16294 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16295 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16296 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16297 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016298
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016299res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16300 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16301 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16302 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16303 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016305res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16306shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16307 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16308 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16309 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16310 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16311 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16312 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016314res.ver : string
16315resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16316 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16317 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016319 ACL derivatives :
16320 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016322set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16323 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16324 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016325 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016326 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016328 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16329 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016331status : integer
16332 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16333 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16334 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016335
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016336unique-id : string
16337 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16338 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16339 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16340 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16341 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16342 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016344url : string
16345 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16346 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16347 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16348 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16349 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16350 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16351 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016353 ACL derivatives :
16354 url : exact string match
16355 url_beg : prefix match
16356 url_dir : subdir match
16357 url_dom : domain match
16358 url_end : suffix match
16359 url_len : length match
16360 url_reg : regex match
16361 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016363url_ip : ip
16364 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16365 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16366 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16367 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16368 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16369 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16370 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016372url_port : integer
16373 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16374 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16375 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16376 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016377
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016378urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16379url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016380 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16381 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016382 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16383 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16384 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16385 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016386 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16387 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016388 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16389 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016391 ACL derivatives :
16392 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16393 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16394 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16395 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16396 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16397 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16398 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16399 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016400
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016402 Example :
16403 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16404 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16405 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16406 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016407
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016408urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016409 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16410 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16411 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016412
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016413url32 : integer
16414 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16415 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16416 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16417 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16418 is an unsigned integer.
16419
16420url32+src : binary
16421 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16422 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16423 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16424
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200164267.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016427---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016428
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016429Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16430every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016431order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016432
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016433ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16434---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016435FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016436HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016437HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16438HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016439HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16440HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16441HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16442HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16443LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016444METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016445METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016446METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16447METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16448METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16449METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016450METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016451METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016452RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016453REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016454TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016455WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16456---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016457
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016458
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164598. Logging
16460----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016461
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016462One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16463provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16464very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16465provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16466state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016467to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016468headers.
16469
16470In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16471about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16472send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16473
16474 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16475 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16476 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16477 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16478 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016479 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016480 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016481
16482The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16483allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16484as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16485while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16486real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16487delay.
16488
16489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164908.1. Log levels
16491---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016492
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016493TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016494source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016495HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16496in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16497track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16498syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16499about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016500
16501
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165028.2. Log formats
16503----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016504
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016505HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016506and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16507slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16508options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016509
16510 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16511 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16512 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16513 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16514 extents.
16515
16516 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16517 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16518 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16519 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16520 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16521
16522 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16523 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16524 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16525 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16526 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16527
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016528 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16529 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16530 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16531 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16532
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016533 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16534
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016535Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16536specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16537field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16538servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16539always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16540identifier.
16541
16542Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16543 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16544 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16545 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16546 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16547
16548
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165498.2.1. Default log format
16550-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016551
16552This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16553as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16554format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16555
16556 Example :
16557 listen www
16558 mode http
16559 log global
16560 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16561
16562 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16563 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16564 (www/HTTP)
16565
16566 Field Format Extract from the example above
16567 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16568 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16569 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16570 4 'to' to
16571 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16572 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16573
16574Detailed fields description :
16575 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16576 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16577 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16578 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16579 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16580 and processed the connection.
16581 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16582
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016583In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16584"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16585connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16586
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016587It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16588will eventually disappear.
16589
16590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165918.2.2. TCP log format
16592---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016593
16594The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16595is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16596information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16597counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16598emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16599environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16600the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16601sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016602specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16603not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16604fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16605marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016606
16607 Example :
16608 frontend fnt
16609 mode tcp
16610 option tcplog
16611 log global
16612 default_backend bck
16613
16614 backend bck
16615 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16616
16617 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16618 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16619 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16620
16621 Field Format Extract from the example above
16622 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16623 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16624 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16625 4 frontend_name fnt
16626 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16627 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16628 7 bytes_read* 212
16629 8 termination_state --
16630 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16631 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16632
16633Detailed fields description :
16634 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016635 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16636 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16637 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016638 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016639 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016640 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016641
16642 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016643 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16644 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16645 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016646
16647 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16648 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16649 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016650 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16651 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16652 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16653 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016654
16655 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16656 and processed the connection.
16657
16658 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16659 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16660 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16661 applications.
16662
16663 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16664 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16665 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16666 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16667 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16668
16669 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16670 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16671 See "Timers" below for more details.
16672
16673 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16674 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16675 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16676 "Timers" below for more details.
16677
16678 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016679 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016680 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16681 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16682 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16683 details.
16684
16685 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16686 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16687 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16688 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16689 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16690
16691 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16692 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16693 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16694 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16695 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16696 for more details.
16697
16698 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016699 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016700 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16701 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16702 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016703 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016704
16705 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16706 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16707 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16708 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16709 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16710 caused by a denial of service attack.
16711
16712 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16713 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16714 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16715 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16716 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16717 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16718 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16719 denial of service attack.
16720
16721 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16722 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16723 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16724 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16725 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16726 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16727 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16728 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16729 be processed than on other servers.
16730
16731 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16732 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16733 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16734 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16735 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16736 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16737 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16738 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16739 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16740 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16741 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16742 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16743 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16744
16745 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16746 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16747 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16748 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16749 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16750 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016751 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016752 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16753
16754 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16755 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16756 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16757 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16758 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16759 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016760 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016761 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16762 occurs.
16763
16764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167658.2.3. HTTP log format
16766----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016767
16768The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16769is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16770the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16771are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16772emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16773generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16774"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16775which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016776frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16777is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016778
16779Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16780slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16781with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16782
16783 Example :
16784 frontend http-in
16785 mode http
16786 option httplog
16787 log global
16788 default_backend bck
16789
16790 backend static
16791 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16792
16793 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16794 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16795 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016796 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016797
16798 Field Format Extract from the example above
16799 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16800 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016801 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016802 4 frontend_name http-in
16803 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016804 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016805 7 status_code 200
16806 8 bytes_read* 2750
16807 9 captured_request_cookie -
16808 10 captured_response_cookie -
16809 11 termination_state ----
16810 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16811 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16812 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16813 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16814 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016815
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016816Detailed fields description :
16817 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016818 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16819 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16820 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016821 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016822 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016823 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016824
16825 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016826 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16827 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16828 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016829
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016830 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16831 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016832
16833 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16834 and processed the connection.
16835
16836 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16837 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16838 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16839
16840 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16841 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16842 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16843 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16844 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16845 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16846
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016847 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16848 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16849 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16850 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16851 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16852 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016853 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16854 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016855
16856 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16857 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016858 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016859
16860 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16861 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016862 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16863 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016864
16865 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16866 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16867 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16868 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16869 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016870 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16871 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016872
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016873 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16874 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16875 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16876 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16877 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16878 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16879 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016880 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016881
16882 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16883 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16884 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16885
16886 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16887 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16888 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16889 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16890 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16891 overflowing.
16892
16893 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16894 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16895 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16896 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16897 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16898 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16899 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16900 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16901
16902 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16903 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16904 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16905 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16906 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16907 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16908 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16909 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16910
16911 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16912 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16913 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16914 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16915 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16916 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16917 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16918
16919 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016920 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016921 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16922 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16923 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016924 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016925 system.
16926
16927 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16928 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16929 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16930 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16931 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16932 caused by a denial of service attack.
16933
16934 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16935 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16936 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16937 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16938 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16939 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16940 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16941 denial of service attack.
16942
16943 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16944 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16945 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16946 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16947 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16948 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16949 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16950 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16951 processed than on other servers.
16952
16953 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16954 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16955 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16956 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16957 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16958 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16959 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16960 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16961 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16962 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16963 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16964 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16965 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16966
16967 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16968 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16969 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16970 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16971 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16972 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016973 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016974 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16975
16976 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16977 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16978 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16979 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16980 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16981 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016982 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016983 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16984 occurs.
16985
16986 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16987 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16988 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16989 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16990 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16991 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16992 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16993 cookies" below for more details.
16994
16995 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16996 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16997 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16998 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16999 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17000 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17001 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17002 and cookies" below for more details.
17003
17004 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17005 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17006 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17007 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17008 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17009 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17010 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17011 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17012
17013
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200170148.2.4. Custom log format
17015------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017016
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017017The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017018mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017019
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017020HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017021Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17022separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17023prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17024
17025Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17026variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017027("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017028
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017029If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017030as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017031less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17032the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17033
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017034Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017035In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017036in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017037
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017038Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17039'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17040https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17041such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17042
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017043Flags are :
17044 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017045 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017046 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17047 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017048
17049 Example:
17050
17051 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17052 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17053
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017054 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17055
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017056At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17057
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017058 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17059 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017060
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017061the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017062
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017063 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17064 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17065 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017066
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017067and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17068
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017069 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17070 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017071
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017072Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17073
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017074 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017075 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017076 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17077 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17078 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017079 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17080 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17081 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017082 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017083 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17084 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017085 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017086 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17087 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017088 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017089 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017090 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017091 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017092 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017093 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017094 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017095 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17096 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17097 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17098 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17099 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017100 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017101 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17102 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017103 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017104 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17105 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017106 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17107 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17108 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017109 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017110 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17111 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017112 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017113 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17114 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17115 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017116 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017117 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017118 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17119 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17120 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17121 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017122 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017123 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017124 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017125 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017126 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017127 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017128 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17129 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17130 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017131 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017132 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17133 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017134 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017135 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17136 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017137 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017138 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017139 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017140 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017141
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017142 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017143
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017144
171458.2.5. Error log format
17146-----------------------
17147
17148When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17149protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17150By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17151"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017152will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017153logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17154
17155The format looks like this :
17156
17157 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17158 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17159 Connection error during SSL handshake
17160
17161 Field Format Extract from the example above
17162 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17163 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17164 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17165 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17166 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17167
17168These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17169failures.
17170
17171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171728.3. Advanced logging options
17173-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017174
17175Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17176just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17177options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17178for more information about their usage.
17179
17180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171818.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17182------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017183
17184It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17185haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17186commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17187monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17188ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17189
17190 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17191 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17192 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17193 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17194
17195 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17196 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17197 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017198 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017199 such as other load-balancers.
17200
17201 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17202 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17203 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17204
17205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17207----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017208
17209The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17210what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17211or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017212"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017213just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17214log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17215after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17216is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17217with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17218with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17219
17220
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172218.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17222------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017223
17224Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17225for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17226"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17227retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17228raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17229a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17230file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17231you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17232"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17233
17234
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172358.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17236--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017237
17238Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17239multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17240them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17241"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17242logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17243error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17244and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17245too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17246useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17247alternative.
17248
17249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172508.4. Timing events
17251------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017252
17253Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17254reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17255the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17256frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017257mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17258addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17259
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017260Timings events in HTTP mode:
17261
17262 first request 2nd request
17263 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17264 t tr t tr ...
17265 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17266 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17267 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17268 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17269 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17270
17271Timings events in TCP mode:
17272
17273 TCP session
17274 |<----------------->|
17275 t t
17276 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17277 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17278 |<------ Tt ------->|
17279
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017280 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017281 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017282 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17283 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17284 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017285 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017286 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17287 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17288 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17289 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017290
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017291 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17292 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17293 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017294 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17295 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17296 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17297 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17298 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17299 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017300
17301 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17302 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17303 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17304 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17305 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17306 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17307 request typed by hand during a test.
17308
17309 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17310 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017311 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017312 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17313 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17314 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17315 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017316
17317 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17318 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17319 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17320 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17321 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17322
17323 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17324 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17325 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17326 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17327 connection never established.
17328
17329 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17330 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17331 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17332 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17333 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17334 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17335 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17336 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17337 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17338 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17339 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17340
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017341 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17342 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17343 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17344 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17345 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17346 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17347
17348 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17349
17350 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17351 "Ta" can never be negative.
17352
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017353 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17354 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017355 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17356 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017357 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017358
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017359 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017360
17361 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017362 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17363 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017364
17365These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17366protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17367that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017368due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17369"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17370that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017371
17372Most common cases :
17373
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017374 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17375 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17376 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17377 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17378 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17379 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17380 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17381 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17382 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17383 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17384 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017385 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017386
17387 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17388 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17389 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17390 of ms on remote networks.
17391
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017392 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17393 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17394 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017395
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017396 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17397 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17398 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17399 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17400 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17401 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17402 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17403 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17404 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017405
17406Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17407
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017408 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017409 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017410 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017411
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017412 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017413 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17414 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17415
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017416 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017417 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17418 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17419 flags.
17420
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017421 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17422 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017423 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17424 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17425 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17426 the client connection was maintained open.
17427
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017428 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017429 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017430 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017431 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17432
17433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174348.5. Session state at disconnection
17435-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017436
17437TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17438"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
174392-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17440each of which has a special meaning :
17441
17442 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17443 session to terminate :
17444
17445 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17446
17447 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17448 server explicitly refused it.
17449
17450 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17451 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17452 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17453 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017454 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017455
17456 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17457 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017458
17459 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17460 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17461 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17462 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17463 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17464
17465 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17466 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17467 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17468 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17469 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17470
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017471 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17472 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17473
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017474 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17475 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17476 backup connections when going up.
17477
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017478 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17479
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017480 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17481 send or receive data.
17482
17483 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17484 send or receive data.
17485
17486 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17487 with nothing left in the buffers.
17488
17489 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17490
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017491 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017492 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17493
17494 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17495 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17496 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17497 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17498 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17499
17500 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17501 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17502
17503 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17504 server (HTTP only).
17505
17506 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17507
17508 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17509 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17510 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17511
17512 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17513 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17514 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17515
17516 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17517
17518 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17519 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17520
17521 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17522 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17523 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17524
17525 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17526 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017527 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17528 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017529
17530 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17531 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17532 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17533 another server.
17534
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017535 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017536 server.
17537
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017538 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17539 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17540 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17541 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17542
17543 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17544 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17545 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17546 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17547
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017548 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17549 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17550 "use-server" rule).
17551
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017552 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17553
17554 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17555 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17556
17557 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17558
17559 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17560 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17561 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17562
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017563 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17564 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017565 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017566 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17567 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17568
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017569 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17570
17571 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17572 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17573
17574 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17575
17576 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17577
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017578The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17579was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017580helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17581starvation, attacks, etc...
17582
17583The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17584alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17585easier finding and understanding.
17586
17587 Flags Reason
17588
17589 -- Normal termination.
17590
17591 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17592 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17593 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17594 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17595
17596 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17597 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17598 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17599 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17600 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17601 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017602
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017603 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17604 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017605 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017606
17607 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17608 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17609 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17610
17611 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17612 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17613 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17614 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17615 the server takes too long to respond.
17616
17617 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17618 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17619 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17620 long a time to respond.
17621
17622 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17623 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17624 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17625 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017626 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17627 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017628
17629 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17630 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17631 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17632 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17633 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017634 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017635 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17636 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17637 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17638 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17639 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17640 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17641 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17642 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017643 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017644 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17645 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17646 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017647
17648 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17649 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017650 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17651 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17652 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17653 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017654
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017655 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17656 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17657
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017658 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017659 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17660 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017661 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017662 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17663 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17664
17665 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17666 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17667 503 or 504 here.
17668
17669 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17670 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17671 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17672 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17673 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17674
17675 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17676 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017677 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017678 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17679 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17680
17681 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17682 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17683 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17684 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17685 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17686 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17687 between haproxy and the server.
17688
17689 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17690 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17691 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17692 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17693 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17694 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17695 solution is to fix the application.
17696
17697 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17698 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17699 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17700 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17701 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17702 external attacks.
17703
17704 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17705 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017706 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017707 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17708 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17709
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017710 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17711 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17712 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017713 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017714 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017715
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017716 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17717 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17718 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17719 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017720 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17721 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17722 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17723 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17724 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017725
17726 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17727 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17728 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17729 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17730
17731 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17732 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17733 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17734 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17735
17736 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17737 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17738 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17739 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17740
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017741The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17742persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17743important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17744re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17745
17746 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17747
17748 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17749 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17750 set on a GET request.
17751
17752 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17753 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017754 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017755 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17756
17757 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17758 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17759 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17760
17761 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17762 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17763 already got a cookie.
17764
17765 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17766 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17767 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17768 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17769 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17770
17771 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17772 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17773 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17774
17775 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17776 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17777 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17778
17779 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17780 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17781
17782 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17783 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17784 then advertised in the response.
17785
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017786
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177878.6. Non-printable characters
17788-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017789
17790In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17791consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17792converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17793prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17794being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17795escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17796is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17797'}' when logging headers.
17798
17799Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17800issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17801containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17802
17803Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17804the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17805performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17806
17807
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178088.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17809---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017810
17811Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17812achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017813section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017814cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17815the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17816the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017817locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017818not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17819user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17820a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17821wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17822
17823 Examples :
17824 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17825 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17826
17827 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17828 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17829
17830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178318.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17832---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017833
17834Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17835proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17836the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17837server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17838
17839Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17840response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017841section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017842
17843It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017844time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17845appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017846are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17847and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17848follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17849request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17850in the logs.
17851
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017852As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17853frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17854an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17855
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017856 Example :
17857 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17858 listen proxy-out
17859 mode http
17860 option httplog
17861 option logasap
17862 log global
17863 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17864
17865 # log the name of the virtual server
17866 capture request header Host len 20
17867
17868 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17869 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17870
17871 # log the beginning of the referrer
17872 capture request header Referer len 20
17873
17874 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17875 capture response header Server len 20
17876
17877 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17878 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17879
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017880 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017881 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17882
17883 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17884 capture response header Via len 20
17885
17886 # log the URL location during a redirection
17887 capture response header Location len 20
17888
17889 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17890 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17891 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17892 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17893 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17894
17895 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17896 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17897 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17898 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017899 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017900
17901 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17902 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17903 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17904 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17905 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017906 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017907
17908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179098.9. Examples of logs
17910---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017911
17912These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17913them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17914reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17915
17916 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17917 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17918 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17919
17920 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17921 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17922
17923 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17924 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17925 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17926
17927 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17928 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17929
17930 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17931 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17932 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17933
17934 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017935 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017936 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17937 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17938
17939 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17940 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17941 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17942
17943 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17944 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017945 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017946 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17947 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17948 to return the 502 and not the server.
17949
17950 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017951 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017952
17953 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17954 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17955 Nothing was sent to any server.
17956
17957 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17958 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17959
17960 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17961 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017962 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017963 send a 408 return code to the client.
17964
17965 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17966 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17967
17968 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17969 5 seconds ("c----").
17970
17971 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17972 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017973 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017974
17975 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017976 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017977 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17978 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17979 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17980 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17981 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017982
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017983
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200179849. Supported filters
17985--------------------
17986
17987Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17988accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17989unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17990
17991See also : "filter"
17992
179939.1. Trace
17994----------
17995
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017996filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017997
17998 Arguments:
17999 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18000 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18001
18002 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18003 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18004 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18005 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18006
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018007 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018008 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18009 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18010 amount of the parsed data.
18011
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018012 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018013
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018014This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18015callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18016information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18017filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18018
18019Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18020tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18021a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18022
18023
180249.2. HTTP compression
18025---------------------
18026
18027filter compression
18028
18029The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18030keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018031when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18032it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18033response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18034line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18035cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18036the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018037
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018038See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018039
18040
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200180419.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18042--------------------------------------------
18043
18044filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18045
18046 Arguments :
18047
18048 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18049 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18050 parsed.
18051
18052 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18053 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18054 part must be placed in its own scope.
18055
18056The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18057external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018058streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018059exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18060also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18061
18062SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18063the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18064
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018065For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018066"doc/SPOE.txt".
18067
18068Important note:
18069 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18070 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18071
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100180729.4. Cache
18073----------
18074
18075filter cache <name>
18076
18077 Arguments :
18078
18079 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18080
18081The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18082"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
18083cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018084other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18085the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18086mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18087filter other than the compression is used for the same
18088listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18089order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018090
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018091See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018092
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001809310. Cache
18094---------
18095
18096HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18097(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18098RAM.
18099
18100The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018101this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018102
18103If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18104independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18105when we try to allocate a new one.
18106
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018107The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018108
18109It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18110"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18111for more details.
18112
18113When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18114replaced by "<CACHE>".
18115
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001811610.1. Limitation
18117----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018118
18119The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18120
18121- If the response is not a 200
18122- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018123- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018124- If the response is not cacheable
18125
18126- If the request is not a GET
18127- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018128- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018129
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018130Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18131filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18132can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18133example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18134"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018135
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001813610.2. Setup
18137-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018138
18139To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18140the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18141
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001814210.2.1. Cache section
18143---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018144
18145cache <name>
18146 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18147 size of cache is mandatory.
18148
18149total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018150 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018151 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018152
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018153max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018154 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18155 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18156 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018157
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018158max-age <seconds>
18159 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18160 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18161 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18162 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18163 default.
18164
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001816510.2.2. Proxy section
18166---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018167
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018168http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018169 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18170 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18171 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18172 after this one.
18173
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018174http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018175 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18176 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18177 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18178 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18179
18180
18181Example:
18182
18183 backend bck1
18184 mode http
18185
18186 http-request cache-use foobar
18187 http-response cache-store foobar
18188 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18189
18190 cache foobar
18191 total-max-size 4
18192 max-age 240
18193
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018194/*
18195 * Local variables:
18196 * fill-column: 79
18197 * End:
18198 */